Merge from emacs-24; up to 2012-12-29T06:14:00Z!cyd@gnu.org
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / org.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.3f (GNU Emacs 24.3)
6
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
11
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
18 @c %**end of header
19 @finalout
20
21
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
23
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
26
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
29
30 @set cmdnames
31
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
33
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
45
46 @c a key but no command
47 @c Inserts: @item key
48 @macro orgkey{key}
49 @kindex \key\
50 @item @kbd{\key\}
51 @end macro
52
53 @macro xorgkey{key}
54 @kindex \key\
55 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
56 @end macro
57
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
61 @ifset cmdnames
62 @kindex \key\
63 @findex \command\
64 @iftex
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
66 @end iftex
67 @ifnottex
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
69 @end ifnottex
70 @end ifset
71 @ifclear cmdnames
72 @kindex \key\
73 @item @kbd{\key\}
74 @end ifclear
75 @end macro
76
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
80 @ifset cmdnames
81 @kindex \key\
82 @findex \command\
83 @iftex
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
85 @end iftex
86 @ifnottex
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
88 @end ifnottex
89 @end ifset
90 @ifclear cmdnames
91 @kindex \key\
92 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
93 @end ifclear
94 @end macro
95
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
99 @ifset cmdnames
100 @findex \command\
101 @iftex
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
103 @end iftex
104 @ifnottex
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
106 @end ifnottex
107 @end ifset
108 @ifclear cmdnames
109 @item @kbd{\key\}
110 @end ifclear
111 @end macro
112
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
116 @ifset cmdnames
117 @kindex \key\
118 @findex \command\
119 @iftex
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
121 @end iftex
122 @ifnottex
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
124 @end ifnottex
125 @end ifset
126 @ifclear cmdnames
127 @kindex \key\
128 @item @kbd{\text\}
129 @end ifclear
130 @end macro
131
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
135 @ifset cmdnames
136 @kindex \key1\
137 @kindex \key2\
138 @findex \command\
139 @iftex
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
141 @end iftex
142 @ifnottex
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
144 @end ifnottex
145 @end ifset
146 @ifclear cmdnames
147 @kindex \key1\
148 @kindex \key2\
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
150 @end ifclear
151 @end macro
152
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
154 @c @itemx
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
158 @ifset cmdnames
159 @kindex \key1\
160 @kindex \key2\
161 @findex \command\
162 @iftex
163 @item @kbd{\key1\}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
165 @end iftex
166 @ifnottex
167 @item @kbd{\key1\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
169 @end ifnottex
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear cmdnames
172 @kindex \key1\
173 @kindex \key2\
174 @item @kbd{\key1\}
175 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
176 @end ifclear
177 @end macro
178
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
182 @ifset cmdnames
183 @kindex \key1\
184 @kindex \key2\
185 @findex \command\
186 @iftex
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
188 @end iftex
189 @ifnottex
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
191 @end ifnottex
192 @end ifset
193 @ifclear cmdnames
194 @kindex \key1\
195 @kindex \key2\
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
197 @end ifclear
198 @end macro
199
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
203 @ifset cmdnames
204 @kindex \key1\
205 @kindex \key2\
206 @findex \command\
207 @iftex
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
209 @end iftex
210 @ifnottex
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
212 @end ifnottex
213 @end ifset
214 @ifclear cmdnames
215 @kindex \key1\
216 @kindex \key2\
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
218 @end ifclear
219 @end macro
220
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
225 @ifset cmdnames
226 @kindex \key1\
227 @kindex \key2\
228 @findex \command1\
229 @findex \command2\
230 @iftex
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
233 @end iftex
234 @ifnottex
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
237 @end ifnottex
238 @end ifset
239 @ifclear cmdnames
240 @kindex \key1\
241 @kindex \key2\
242 @item @kbd{\key1\}
243 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
244 @end ifclear
245 @end macro
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
247
248 @iftex
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
250 @end iftex
251
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
254 @ifinfo
255 @subsubheading \text\
256 @end ifinfo
257 @ifnotinfo
258 @item @b{\text\}
259 @end ifnotinfo
260 @end macro
261
262 @copying
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
264
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
266
267 @quotation
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
274
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual.''
277 @end quotation
278 @end copying
279
280 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
281 @direntry
282 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
283 @end direntry
284
285 @titlepage
286 @title The Org Manual
287
288 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
289 @author by Carsten Dominik
290 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
291
292 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
293 @page
294 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
295 @insertcopying
296 @end titlepage
297
298 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
299 @contents
300
301 @ifnottex
302 @c FIXME These hand-written next,prev,up node pointers make editing a lot
303 @c harder. There should be no need for them, makeinfo can do it
304 @c automatically for any document with a normal structure.
305 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
306 @top Org Mode Manual
307
308 @insertcopying
309 @end ifnottex
310
311 @menu
312 * Introduction:: Getting started
313 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
314 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
315 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
316 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
317 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
318 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
319 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
320 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
321 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
322 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
323 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
324 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
325 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
326 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
327 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
328 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
329 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
330 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
331 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
332 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
333 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
334 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
335
336 @detailmenu
337 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
338
339 Introduction
340
341 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
342 * Installation:: Installing Org
343 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
344 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
345 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
346
347 Document structure
348
349 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
350 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
351 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
352 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
353 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
354 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
355 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
356 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
357 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
358 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
359 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
360
361 Tables
362
363 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
364 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
365 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
366 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
367 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
368 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
369
370 The spreadsheet
371
372 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
373 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
374 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
375 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
376 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
377 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
378 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
379 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
380 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
381
382 Hyperlinks
383
384 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
385 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
386 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
387 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
388 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
389 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
390 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
391 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
392
393 Internal links
394
395 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
396
397 TODO items
398
399 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
400 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
401 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
402 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
403 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
404 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
405
406 Extended use of TODO keywords
407
408 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
409 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
410 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
411 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
412 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
413 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
414 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
415
416 Progress logging
417
418 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
419 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
420 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
421
422 Tags
423
424 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
425 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
426 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
427
428 Properties and columns
429
430 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
431 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
432 * Property searches:: Matching property values
433 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
434 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
435 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
436
437 Column view
438
439 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
440 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
441 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
442
443 Defining columns
444
445 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
446 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
447
448 Dates and times
449
450 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
451 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
452 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
453 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
454 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
455 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
456 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
457
458 Creating timestamps
459
460 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
461 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
462
463 Deadlines and scheduling
464
465 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
466 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
467
468 Clocking work time
469
470 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
471 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
472 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
473
474 Capture - Refile - Archive
475
476 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
477 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
478 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
479 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
480 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
481 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
482
483 Capture
484
485 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
486 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
487 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
488
489 Capture templates
490
491 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
492 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
493 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
494
495 Archiving
496
497 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
498 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
499
500 Agenda views
501
502 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
503 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
504 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
505 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
506 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
507 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
508 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
509 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
510
511 The built-in agenda views
512
513 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
514 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
515 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
516 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
517 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
518 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
519
520 Presentation and sorting
521
522 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
523 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
524 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
525
526 Custom agenda views
527
528 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
529 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
530 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
531
532 Markup for rich export
533
534 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
535 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
536 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
537 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
538 * Index entries:: Making an index
539 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
540 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
541
542 Structural markup elements
543
544 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
545 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
546 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
547 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
548 * Lists:: Lists
549 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
550 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
551 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
552 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
553 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
554
555 Embedded @LaTeX{}
556
557 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
558 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
559 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
560 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
561 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
562
563 Exporting
564
565 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
566 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
567 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
568 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
569 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
570 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
571 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
572 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
573 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
574 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
575 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
576 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
577
578 HTML export
579
580 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
581 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
582 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
583 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
584 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
585 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
586 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
587 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
588 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
589 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
590
591 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
592
593 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
594 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
595 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
596 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
597 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
598 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
599
600 DocBook export
601
602 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
603 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
604 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
605 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
606 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
607 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
608
609 OpenDocument Text export
610
611 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
612 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
613 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
614 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
615 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
616 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
617 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
618 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
619 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
620 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
621 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
622
623 Math formatting in ODT export
624
625 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
626 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
627
628 Advanced topics in ODT export
629
630 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
631 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
632 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
633 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
634 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
635
636 Publishing
637
638 * Configuration:: Defining projects
639 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
640 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
641 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
642
643 Configuration
644
645 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
646 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
647 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
648 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
649 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
650 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
651 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
652 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
653
654 Sample configuration
655
656 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
657 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
658
659 Working with source code
660
661 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
662 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
663 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
664 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
665 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
666 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
667 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
668 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
669 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
670 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
671 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
672 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
673
674 Header arguments
675
676 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
677 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
678
679 Using header arguments
680
681 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
682 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
683 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
684 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
685 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
686 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
687
688 Specific header arguments
689
690 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
691 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
692 be collected and handled
693 * file:: Specify a path for file output
694 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
695 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
696 directory for code block execution
697 * exports:: Export code and/or results
698 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
699 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
700 files during tangling
701 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
702 code files
703 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
704 code files
705 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
706 expansion during tangling
707 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
708 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
709 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
710 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
711 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
712 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
713 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
714 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
715 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
716 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
717 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
718 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
719
720 Miscellaneous
721
722 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
723 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
724 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
725 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
726 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
727 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
728 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
729 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
730 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
731 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
732 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
733
734 Interaction with other packages
735
736 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
737 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
738
739 Hacking
740
741 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
742 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
743 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
744 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
745 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
746 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
747 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
748 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
749 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
750 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
751
752 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
753
754 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
755 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
756 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
757 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
758
759 MobileOrg
760
761 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
762 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
763 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
764
765 @end detailmenu
766 @end menu
767
768 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
769 @chapter Introduction
770 @cindex introduction
771
772 @menu
773 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
774 * Installation:: Installing Org
775 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
776 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
777 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
778 @end menu
779
780 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
781 @section Summary
782 @cindex summary
783
784 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
785 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
786
787 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
788 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
789 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
790 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
791 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
792 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
793 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
794 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
795 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
796 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
797 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
798 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
799 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
800 linked web pages.
801
802 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
803 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
804 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
805
806 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
807 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
808 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
809
810 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
811 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
812 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
813 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
814 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
815 the minor Orgstruct mode.
816
817 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
818 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
819 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
820 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
821 ends, for example:
822
823 @example
824 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
825 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
826 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
827 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
828 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
829 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
830 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
831 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
832 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
833 @end example
834
835 @cindex FAQ
836 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
837 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
838 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
839 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
840
841 @cindex print edition
842 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
843 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
844 Theory Ltd.}
845
846 @page
847
848
849 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
850 @section Installation
851 @cindex installation
852 @cindex XEmacs
853
854 Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need
855 to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top
856 of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
857
858 @itemize @bullet
859 @item By using Emacs package system.
860 @item By downloading Org as an archive.
861 @item By using Org's git repository.
862 @end itemize
863
864 We @b{strongly recommend} to stick to a single installation method.
865
866 @subsubheading Using Emacs packaging system
867
868 Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install
869 Elisp libraries. You can install Org with @kbd{M-x package-install RET org}.
870 To make sure your Org configuration is well taken into account, initialize
871 the package system with @code{(package-initialize)} before setting any Org
872 option. If you want to use Org's package repository, check out the
873 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}.
874
875 @subsubheading Downloading Org as an archive
876
877 You can download Org latest release from @uref{http://orgmode.org/, Org's
878 website}. In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your
879 @file{.emacs}:
880
881 @example
882 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
883 @end example
884
885 The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included
886 in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the @file{contrib} directory to your
887 load-path:
888
889 @example
890 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
891 @end example
892
893 Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system.
894 Run @code{make help} to list compilation and installation options.
895
896 @subsubheading Using Org's git repository
897
898 You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
899
900 @example
901 $ cd ~/src/
902 $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git
903 $ make autoloads
904 @end example
905
906 Note that in this case, @code{make autoloads} is mandatory: it defines Org's
907 version in @file{org-version.el} and Org's autoloads in
908 @file{org-loaddefs.el}.
909
910 Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above.
911
912 You can also compile with @code{make}, generate the documentation with
913 @code{make doc}, create a local configuration with @code{make config} and
914 install Org with @code{make install}. Please run @code{make help} to get
915 the list of compilation/installation options.
916
917 For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org
918 Build System page on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html,
919 Worg}.
920
921 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
922 @section Activation
923 @cindex activation
924 @cindex autoload
925 @cindex ELPA
926 @cindex global key bindings
927 @cindex key bindings, global
928 @findex org-agenda
929 @findex org-capture
930 @findex org-store-link
931 @findex org-iswitchb
932
933 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
934 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
935 @file{.emacs} file:
936
937 @lisp
938 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
939 @end lisp
940
941 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
942 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
943 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
944
945 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
946 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
947
948 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
949 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
950 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
951 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
952 liking.
953 @lisp
954 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
955 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
956 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
957 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
958 @end lisp
959
960 @cindex Org mode, turning on
961 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
962 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
963 like this:
964
965 @example
966 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
967 @end example
968
969 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
970 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
971 the file's name is. See also the variable
972 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
973
974 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
975 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
976 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
977 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
978 @lisp
979 (transient-mark-mode 1)
980 @end lisp
981 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
982 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
983 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
984
985 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
986 @section Feedback
987 @cindex feedback
988 @cindex bug reports
989 @cindex maintainer
990 @cindex author
991
992 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
993 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
994 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
995 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
996 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
997 moderators have to do.}.
998
999 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1000 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1001 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1002 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1003 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1004 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1005 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1006 @example
1007 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1008 @end example
1009 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1010 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1011 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1012
1013 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1014 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1015 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1016 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1017 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1018
1019 @example
1020 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1021 @end example
1022
1023 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1024 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1025 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1026 shown below.
1027
1028 @example
1029 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1030
1031 ;; activate debugging
1032 (setq debug-on-error t
1033 debug-on-signal nil
1034 debug-on-quit nil)
1035
1036 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1037 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1038 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1039 @end example
1040
1041 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1042 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1043 about:
1044
1045 @enumerate
1046 @item What exactly did you do?
1047 @item What did you expect to happen?
1048 @item What happened instead?
1049 @end enumerate
1050 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1051
1052 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1053
1054 @cindex backtrace of an error
1055 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1056 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1057 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1058 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1059 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1060
1061 @enumerate
1062 @item
1063 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1064 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1065 To do this, use
1066 @example
1067 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1068 @end example
1069 @noindent
1070 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1071 menu.
1072 @item
1073 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1074 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1075 @item
1076 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1077 document the steps you take.
1078 @item
1079 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1080 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1081 attach it to your bug report.
1082 @end enumerate
1083
1084 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1085 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1086
1087 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1088
1089 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1090 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1091
1092 @table @code
1093 @item TODO
1094 @itemx WAITING
1095 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1096 user-defined.
1097 @item boss
1098 @itemx ARCHIVE
1099 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1100 meaning are written with all capitals.
1101 @item Release
1102 @itemx PRIORITY
1103 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1104 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1105 @end table
1106
1107 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1108 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1109 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1110 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1111 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1112 @code{#+results}.}
1113
1114 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1115 @kindex C-c a
1116 @findex org-agenda
1117 @kindex C-c c
1118 @findex org-capture
1119
1120 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1121 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1122 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1123
1124 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1125 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1126 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1127 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1128 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1129 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1130 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1131 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1132 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1133 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1134
1135 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1136 @chapter Document structure
1137 @cindex document structure
1138 @cindex structure of document
1139
1140 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1141 edit the structure of the document.
1142
1143 @menu
1144 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1145 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1146 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1147 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1148 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1149 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1150 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1151 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1152 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1153 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1154 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1155 @end menu
1156
1157 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1158 @section Outlines
1159 @cindex outlines
1160 @cindex Outline mode
1161
1162 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1163 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1164 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1165 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1166 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1167 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1168 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1169 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1170
1171 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1172 @section Headlines
1173 @cindex headlines
1174 @cindex outline tree
1175 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1176 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1177 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1178
1179 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1180 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1181 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1182 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1183 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1184 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1185
1186 @example
1187 * Top level headline
1188 ** Second level
1189 *** 3rd level
1190 some text
1191 *** 3rd level
1192 more text
1193
1194 * Another top level headline
1195 @end example
1196
1197 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1198 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1199 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1200
1201 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1202 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1203 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1204 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1205 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1206 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1207
1208 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1209 @section Visibility cycling
1210 @cindex cycling, visibility
1211 @cindex visibility cycling
1212 @cindex trees, visibility
1213 @cindex show hidden text
1214 @cindex hide text
1215
1216 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1217 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1218 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1219
1220 @cindex subtree visibility states
1221 @cindex subtree cycling
1222 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1223 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1224 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1225 @table @asis
1226 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1227 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1228
1229 @example
1230 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1231 '-----------------------------------'
1232 @end example
1233
1234 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1235 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1236 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1237 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1238 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1239 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1240 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1241 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1242
1243 @cindex global visibility states
1244 @cindex global cycling
1245 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1246 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1247 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1248 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1249 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1250 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1251
1252 @example
1253 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1254 '--------------------------------------'
1255 @end example
1256
1257 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1258 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1259 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1260
1261 @cindex show all, command
1262 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1263 Show all, including drawers.
1264 @cindex revealing context
1265 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1266 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1267 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1268 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1269 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1270 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1271 entire subtree of the parent.
1272 @cindex show branches, command
1273 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1274 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1275 @cindex show children, command
1276 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1277 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1278 expose all children down to level N@.
1279 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1280 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1281 buffer
1282 @ifinfo
1283 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1284 @end ifinfo
1285 @ifnotinfo
1286 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1287 @end ifnotinfo
1288 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1289 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1290 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1291 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1292 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1293 the previously used indirect buffer.
1294 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1295 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1296 @end table
1297
1298 @vindex org-startup-folded
1299 @vindex org-agenda-inhibit-startup
1300 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1301 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1302 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1303 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1304
1305 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1306 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1307 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1308 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1309 buffer:
1310
1311 @example
1312 #+STARTUP: overview
1313 #+STARTUP: content
1314 #+STARTUP: showall
1315 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1316 @end example
1317
1318 The startup visibility options are ignored when the file is open for the
1319 first time during the agenda generation: if you want the agenda to honor
1320 the startup visibility, set @code{org-agenda-inhibit-startup} to nil.
1321
1322 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1323 @noindent
1324 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1325 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1326 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1327 @code{all}.
1328 @table @asis
1329 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1330 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1331 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1332 entries.
1333 @end table
1334
1335 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1336 @section Motion
1337 @cindex motion, between headlines
1338 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1339 @cindex headline navigation
1340 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1341
1342 @table @asis
1343 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1344 Next heading.
1345 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1346 Previous heading.
1347 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1348 Next heading same level.
1349 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1350 Previous heading same level.
1351 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1352 Backward to higher level heading.
1353 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1354 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1355 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1356 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1357 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1358 @example
1359 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1360 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1361 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1362 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1363 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1364 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1365 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1366 u @r{One level up.}
1367 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1368 q @r{Quit}
1369 @end example
1370 @vindex org-goto-interface
1371 @noindent
1372 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1373 @end table
1374
1375 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1376 @section Structure editing
1377 @cindex structure editing
1378 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1379 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1380 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1381 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1382 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1383 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1384 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1385 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1386 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1387
1388 @table @asis
1389 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1390 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1391 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1392 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1393 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1394 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1395 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1396 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1397 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1398 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1399 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1400 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1401 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1402 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1403 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1404 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1405 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1406 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1407 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1408 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1409 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1410 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1411 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1412 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1413 subtree.
1414 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1415 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1416 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1417 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1418 to the initial level.
1419 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1420 Promote current heading by one level.
1421 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1422 Demote current heading by one level.
1423 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1424 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1425 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1426 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1427 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1428 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1429 level).
1430 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1431 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1432 @orgcmd{M-h,org-mark-element}
1433 Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements
1434 of the one just marked. E.g., hitting @key{M-h} on a paragraph will mark it,
1435 hitting @key{M-h} immediately again will mark the next one.
1436 @orgcmd{C-c @@,org-mark-subtree}
1437 Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees
1438 of the same level than the marked subtree.
1439 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1440 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1441 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1442 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1443 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1444 sequential subtrees.
1445 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1446 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1447 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1448 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1449 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1450 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1451 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1452 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1453 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1454 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1455 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1456 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1457 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1458 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1459 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1460 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1461 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1462 folding.
1463 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1464 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1465 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1466 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1467 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1468 more details, see the docstring of the command
1469 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1470 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1471 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1472 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1473 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1474 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1475 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1476 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1477 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1478 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1479 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1480 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1481 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1482 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1483 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1484 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1485 Narrow buffer to current block.
1486 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1487 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1488 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1489 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1490 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1491 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1492 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1493 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1494 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1495 @end table
1496
1497 @cindex region, active
1498 @cindex active region
1499 @cindex transient mark mode
1500 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1501 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1502 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1503 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1504 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1505 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1506 functionality.
1507
1508
1509 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1510 @section Sparse trees
1511 @cindex sparse trees
1512 @cindex trees, sparse
1513 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1514 @cindex occur, command
1515
1516 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1517 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1518 @vindex org-show-siblings
1519 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1520 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1521 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1522 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1523 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1524 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1525 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1526 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1527 and you will see immediately how it works.
1528
1529 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1530 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1531
1532 @table @asis
1533 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1534 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1535 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1536 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1537 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1538 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1539 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1540 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1541 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1542 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1543 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1544 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1545 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1546 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1547 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1548 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1549 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1550 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1551 @end table
1552
1553
1554 @noindent
1555 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1556 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1557 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1558 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1559 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1560 For example:
1561
1562 @lisp
1563 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1564 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1565 @end lisp
1566
1567 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1568 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1569
1570 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1571 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1572
1573 @kindex C-c C-e v
1574 @cindex printing sparse trees
1575 @cindex visible text, printing
1576 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1577 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1578 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1579 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1580 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1581 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1582
1583 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1584 @section Plain lists
1585 @cindex plain lists
1586 @cindex lists, plain
1587 @cindex lists, ordered
1588 @cindex ordered lists
1589
1590 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1591 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1592 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1593 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1594
1595 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1596 @itemize @bullet
1597 @item
1598 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1599 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1600 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1601 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1602 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1603 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1604 bullets.
1605 @item
1606 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1607 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1608 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1609 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1610 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1611 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1612 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1613 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1614 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1615 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1616 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1617 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1618 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1619 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1620 @item
1621 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1622 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1623 description.
1624 @end itemize
1625
1626 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1627 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1628 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1629 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1630 than its bullet/number.
1631
1632 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1633 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1634 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1635 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1636 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1637
1638 @example
1639 @group
1640 ** Lord of the Rings
1641 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1642 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1643 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1644 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1645 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1646 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1647 - on DVD only
1648 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1649 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1650 Important actors in this film are:
1651 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1652 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1653 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1654 @end group
1655 @end example
1656
1657 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1658 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1659 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1660 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1661 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1662 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1663 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1664
1665 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1666 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1667 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1668 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1669 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1670 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1671 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1672
1673 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1674 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1675 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1676 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1677 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1678 to disable them individually.
1679
1680 @table @asis
1681 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1682 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1683 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1684 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1685 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1686 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1687 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1688 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1689 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1690 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1691 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1692 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1693 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1694 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1695 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1696 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1697 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1698 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1699 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1700 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1701 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1702 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1703 one.
1704 @end table
1705
1706 @table @kbd
1707 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1708 @item M-S-RET
1709 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1710 @kindex S-@key{down}
1711 @item S-up
1712 @itemx S-down
1713 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1714 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1715 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1716 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1717 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1718 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1719 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1720 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1721 similar effect.
1722 @kindex M-@key{up}
1723 @kindex M-@key{down}
1724 @item M-up
1725 @itemx M-down
1726 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1727 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1728 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1729 is automatic.
1730 @kindex M-@key{left}
1731 @kindex M-@key{right}
1732 @item M-left
1733 @itemx M-right
1734 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1735 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1736 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1737 @item M-S-left
1738 @itemx M-S-right
1739 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1740 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1741 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1742 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1743 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1744 motion or so.
1745
1746 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1747 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1748 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1749 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1750 @kindex C-c C-c
1751 @item C-c C-c
1752 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1753 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1754 consistency in the whole list.
1755 @kindex C-c -
1756 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1757 @item C-c -
1758 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1759 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1760 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1761 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1762 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1763 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1764 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1765 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1766 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1767 @kindex C-c *
1768 @item C-c *
1769 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1770 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1771 @kindex C-c C-*
1772 @item C-c C-*
1773 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1774 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1775 (resp. checked).
1776 @kindex S-@key{left}
1777 @kindex S-@key{right}
1778 @item S-left/right
1779 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1780 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1781 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1782 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1783 @kindex C-c ^
1784 @item C-c ^
1785 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1786 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1787 @end table
1788
1789 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1790 @section Drawers
1791 @cindex drawers
1792 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1793 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1794
1795 @vindex org-drawers
1796 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1797 @kindex C-c C-x d
1798 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1799 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1800 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1801 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1802 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1803 look like this:
1804
1805 @example
1806 ** This is a headline
1807 Still outside the drawer
1808 :DRAWERNAME:
1809 This is inside the drawer.
1810 :END:
1811 After the drawer.
1812 @end example
1813
1814 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1815 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1816 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1817 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1818 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1819 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1820
1821 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1822 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1823 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1824 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1825 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1826 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1827 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1828 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1829
1830 @table @kbd
1831 @kindex C-c C-z
1832 @item C-c C-z
1833 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1834 @end table
1835
1836 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1837 @section Blocks
1838
1839 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1840 @cindex blocks, folding
1841 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1842 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1843 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1844 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1845 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1846 or on a per-file basis by using
1847
1848 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1849 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1850 @example
1851 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1852 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1853 @end example
1854
1855 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1856 @section Footnotes
1857 @cindex footnotes
1858
1859 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1860 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1861 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1862 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1863 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1864 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1865 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1866 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1867
1868 @example
1869 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1870 ...
1871 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1872 @end example
1873
1874 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1875 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1876 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1877 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1878 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1879
1880 @table @code
1881 @item [1]
1882 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1883 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1884 snippet.
1885 @item [fn:name]
1886 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1887 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1888 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1889 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1890 reference point.
1891 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1892 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1893 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1894 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1895 @end table
1896
1897 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1898 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1899 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1900 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1901 for details.
1902
1903 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1904
1905 @table @kbd
1906 @kindex C-c C-x f
1907 @item C-c C-x f
1908 The footnote action command.
1909
1910 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1911 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1912
1913 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1914 @vindex org-footnote-section
1915 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1916 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1917 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1918 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1919 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1920 separately into the location determined by the variable
1921 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1922
1923 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1924 options is offered:
1925 @example
1926 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1927 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1928 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1929 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1930 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1931 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1932 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1933 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1934 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1935 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1936 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1937 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1938 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1939 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1940 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1941 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1942 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1943 @r{to it.}
1944 @end example
1945 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1946 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1947 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1948 deletion.
1949
1950 @kindex C-c C-c
1951 @item C-c C-c
1952 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1953 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1954 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1955 @kindex C-c C-o
1956 @kindex mouse-1
1957 @kindex mouse-2
1958 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1959 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1960 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1964 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1965 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1966 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1967
1968 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1969 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1970 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1971 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1972 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1973
1974 @lisp
1975 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1976 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1977 @end lisp
1978
1979 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1980 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1981 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1982 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1983 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1984 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1985 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1986 item.
1987
1988 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1989 @chapter Tables
1990 @cindex tables
1991 @cindex editing tables
1992
1993 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1994 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1995 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1996
1997 @menu
1998 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1999 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2000 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2001 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2002 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2003 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2004 @end menu
2005
2006 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2007 @section The built-in table editor
2008 @cindex table editor, built-in
2009
2010 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2011 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2012 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2013 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2014 might look like this:
2015
2016 @example
2017 | Name | Phone | Age |
2018 |-------+-------+-----|
2019 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2020 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2021 @end example
2022
2023 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2024 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2025 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2026 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2027 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2028 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2029 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2030 create the above table, you would only type
2031
2032 @example
2033 |Name|Phone|Age|
2034 |-
2035 @end example
2036
2037 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2038 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2039 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2040
2041 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2042 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2043 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2044 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2045 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2046 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2047 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2048 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2049 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2050 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2051
2052 @table @kbd
2053 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2054 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2055 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2056 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2057 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2058 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2059 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2060 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2061 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2062 @*
2063 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2064 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2065 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2066
2067 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2068 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2069 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2070 @c
2071 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2072 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2073 necessary.
2074 @c
2075 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2076 Re-align, move to previous field.
2077 @c
2078 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2079 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2080 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2081 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2082 @c
2083 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2084 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2085 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2086 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2087
2088 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2089 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2090 Move the current column left/right.
2091 @c
2092 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2093 Kill the current column.
2094 @c
2095 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2096 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2097 @c
2098 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2099 Move the current row up/down.
2100 @c
2101 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2102 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2103 @c
2104 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2105 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2106 created below the current one.
2107 @c
2108 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2109 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2110 is created above the current line.
2111 @c
2112 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2113 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2114 below that line.
2115 @c
2116 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2117 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2118 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2119 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2120 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2121 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2122 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2123 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2124 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2125 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2126
2127 @tsubheading{Regions}
2128 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2129 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2130 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2131 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2132 @c
2133 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2134 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2135 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2136 @c
2137 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2138 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2139 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2140 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2141 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2142 lines.
2143 @c
2144 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2145 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2146 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2147 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2148 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2149 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2150 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2151 above.
2152
2153 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2154 @cindex formula, in tables
2155 @cindex calculations, in tables
2156 @cindex region, active
2157 @cindex active region
2158 @cindex transient mark mode
2159 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2160 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2161 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2162 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2163 @c
2164 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2165 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2166 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2167 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2168 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2169 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2170 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2171 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2172 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2173
2174 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2175 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2176 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2177 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2178 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2179 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2180 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2181 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2182 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2183 @c
2184 @item M-x org-table-import
2185 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2186 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2187 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2188 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2189 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2190 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2191 separator.
2192 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2193 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2194 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2195 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2196 @c
2197 @item M-x org-table-export
2198 @findex org-table-export
2199 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2200 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2201 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2202 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2203 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2204 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2205 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2206 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2207 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2208 detailed description.
2209 @end table
2210
2211 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2212 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2213 it off with
2214
2215 @lisp
2216 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2217 @end lisp
2218
2219 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2220 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2221
2222 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2223 @section Column width and alignment
2224 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2225 @cindex alignment in tables
2226
2227 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2228 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2229 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2230
2231 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2232 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2233 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2234 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2235 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2236 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2237 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2238
2239 @example
2240 @group
2241 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2242 | | | | | <6> |
2243 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2244 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2245 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2246 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2247 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2248 @end group
2249 @end example
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2253 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2254 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2255 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2256 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2257 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2258 C-c}.
2259
2260 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2261 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2262 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2263 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2264 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2265 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2266 on a per-file basis with:
2267
2268 @example
2269 #+STARTUP: align
2270 #+STARTUP: noalign
2271 @end example
2272
2273 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2274 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2275 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2276 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2277 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2278
2279 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2280 automatically when exporting the document.
2281
2282 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2283 @section Column groups
2284 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2285
2286 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2287 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2288 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2289 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2290 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2291 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2292 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2293 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2294 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2295 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2296 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2297
2298 @example
2299 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2300 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2301 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2302 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2303 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2304 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2305 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2306 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2307 @end example
2308
2309 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2310 every vertical line you would like to have:
2311
2312 @example
2313 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2314 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2315 | / | < | | | < | |
2316 @end example
2317
2318 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2319 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2320 @cindex Orgtbl mode
2321 @cindex minor mode for tables
2322
2323 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2324 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2325 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2326 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2327 example in Message mode, use
2328
2329 @lisp
2330 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2331 @end lisp
2332
2333 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2334 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2335 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2336 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2337 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2338
2339 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2340 @section The spreadsheet
2341 @cindex calculations, in tables
2342 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2343 @cindex @file{calc} package
2344
2345 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2346 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2347 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2348 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2349 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2350 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2351 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2352 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2353 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2354
2355 @menu
2356 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2357 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2358 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2359 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2360 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2361 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2362 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2363 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2364 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2365 @end menu
2366
2367 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2368 @subsection References
2369 @cindex references
2370
2371 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2372 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2373 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2374 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2375 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2376
2377 @subsubheading Field references
2378 @cindex field references
2379 @cindex references, to fields
2380
2381 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2382 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2383 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2384 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2385 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2386 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2387 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2388 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2389 representation that looks like this:
2390 @example
2391 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2392 @end example
2393
2394 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2395 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2396 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2397 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2398 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2399 column from the right.
2400
2401 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2402 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2403 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2404 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2405 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2406 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2407 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2408 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2409 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2410 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2411 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2412 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2413 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2414 after the third hline in the table.
2415
2416 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2417 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2418 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2419 implied.
2420
2421 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2422 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2423 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2424 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2425 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2426 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2427
2428 Here are a few examples:
2429
2430 @example
2431 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2432 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2433 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2434 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2435 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2436 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2437 @end example
2438
2439 @subsubheading Range references
2440 @cindex range references
2441 @cindex references, to ranges
2442
2443 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2444 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2445 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2446 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2447 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2448 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2449
2450 @example
2451 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2452 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2453 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2454 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2455 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{in the first row up, 3 fields from 2 columns on the left}
2456 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2457 @end example
2458
2459 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2460 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2461 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2462 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2463 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2464
2465 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2466 @cindex field coordinates
2467 @cindex coordinates, of field
2468 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2469 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2470
2471 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2472 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2473 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2474 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2475
2476 @example
2477 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2478 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2479 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2480 @end example
2481
2482 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2483 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2484 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2485 number of rows.
2486
2487 @subsubheading Named references
2488 @cindex named references
2489 @cindex references, named
2490 @cindex name, of column or field
2491 @cindex constants, in calculations
2492 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2493
2494 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2495 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2496 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2497 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2498 line like
2499
2500 @example
2501 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2502 @end example
2503
2504 @noindent
2505 @vindex constants-unit-system
2506 @pindex constants.el
2507 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2508 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2509 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2510 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2511 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2512 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2513 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2514 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2515 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2516 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2517 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2518 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2519 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2520 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2521 numbers.
2522
2523 @subsubheading Remote references
2524 @cindex remote references
2525 @cindex references, remote
2526 @cindex references, to a different table
2527 @cindex name, of column or field
2528 @cindex constants, in calculations
2529 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2530
2531 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2532 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2533
2534 @example
2535 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2536 @end example
2537
2538 @noindent
2539 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2540 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2541 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2542 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2543 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2544 referenced table.
2545
2546 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2547 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2548 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2549 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2550
2551 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2552 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2553 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2554 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2555 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2556 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2557 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2558 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2559 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2560 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2561 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2562
2563 @cindex format specifier
2564 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2565 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2566 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2567 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2568 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2569 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2570 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2571 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2572 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2573
2574 @example
2575 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2576 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2577 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2578 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2579 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2580 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2581 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2582 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2583 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2584 L @r{literal}
2585 @end example
2586
2587 @noindent
2588 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2589 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2590 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2591 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2592 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2593 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2594 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2595 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2596 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2597 A few examples:
2598
2599 @example
2600 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2601 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2602 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2603 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2604 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2605 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2606 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2607 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2608 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2609 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2610 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2611 @end example
2612
2613 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2614
2615 @example
2616 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2617 @end example
2618
2619 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2620 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2621
2622 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2623 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2624 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2625
2626 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2627 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2628 not enough.
2629
2630 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2631 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2632 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2633 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2634
2635 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2636 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2637 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2638 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2639 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2640 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2641 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2642 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2643 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2644 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2645
2646 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2647 computations in Lisp:
2648
2649 @example
2650 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2651 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2652 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2653 '(+ $1 $2);N
2654 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1--4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2655 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2656 @end example
2657
2658 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2659 @subsection Durations and time values
2660 @cindex Duration, computing
2661 @cindex Time, computing
2662 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2663
2664 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2665 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2666
2667 @example
2668 @group
2669 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2670 |---------+----------+----------|
2671 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2672 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2673 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2674 @end group
2675 @end example
2676
2677 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2678 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2679 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2680 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2681 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2682 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2683 example above).
2684
2685 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2686 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2687
2688 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2689 @subsection Field and range formulas
2690 @cindex field formula
2691 @cindex range formula
2692 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2693 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2694
2695 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2696 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2697 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2698 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2699 current field will be replaced with the result.
2700
2701 @cindex #+TBLFM
2702 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2703 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2704 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2705 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2706 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2707 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2708 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2709 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2710 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2711 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2712 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2713
2714 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2715 command
2716
2717 @table @kbd
2718 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2719 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2720 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2721 it to the current field, and stores it.
2722 @end table
2723
2724 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2725 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2726 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2727 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2728 directly.
2729
2730 @table @code
2731 @item $2=
2732 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2733 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2734 @item @@3=
2735 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2736 the last row.
2737 @item @@1$2..@@4$3=
2738 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2739 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2740 @item $name=
2741 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2742 @end table
2743
2744 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2745 @subsection Column formulas
2746 @cindex column formula
2747 @cindex formula, for table column
2748
2749 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2750 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2751 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2752 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2753 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2754 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2755 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2756
2757 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2758 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2759 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2760 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2761 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2762 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2763 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2764 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2765 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2766 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2767
2768 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2769 following command:
2770
2771 @table @kbd
2772 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2773 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2774 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2775 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2776 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2777 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2778 @end table
2779
2780 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2781 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2782 @cindex formula editing
2783 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2784
2785 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2786 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2787 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2788 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2789 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2790 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2791 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2792 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2793
2794 @table @kbd
2795 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2796 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2797 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2798 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2799 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2800 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2801 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2802 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2803 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2804 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2805 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2806 @kindex C-c @}
2807 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2808 @item C-c @}
2809 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2810 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2811 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2812 @kindex C-c @{
2813 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2814 @item C-c @{
2815 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2816 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2817 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2818 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2819 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2820 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2821 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2822 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2823 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2824 @table @kbd
2825 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2826 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2827 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2828 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2829 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2830 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2831 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2832 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2833 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2834 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2835 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2836 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2837 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2838 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2839 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2840 @kindex S-@key{up}
2841 @kindex S-@key{down}
2842 @kindex S-@key{left}
2843 @kindex S-@key{right}
2844 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2845 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2846 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2847 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2848 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2849 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2850 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2851 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2852 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2853 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2854 down.
2855 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2856 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2857 @kindex C-c @}
2858 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2859 @item C-c @}
2860 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2861 @end table
2862 @end table
2863
2864 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2865 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2866 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2867 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2868 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2869
2870 @kindex C-c C-c
2871 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2872 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2873 recalculation commands in the table.
2874
2875 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2876 @cindex formula debugging
2877 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2878 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2879 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2880 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2881 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2882 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2883 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2884
2885 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2886 @subsection Updating the table
2887 @cindex recomputing table fields
2888 @cindex updating, table
2889
2890 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2891 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2892 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2893
2894 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2895 following commands:
2896
2897 @table @kbd
2898 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2899 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2900 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2901 @c
2902 @kindex C-u C-c *
2903 @item C-u C-c *
2904 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2905 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2906 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2907 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2908 @c
2909 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2910 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2911 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2912 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2913 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2914 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2915 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2916 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2917 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2918 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2919 dependencies.
2920 @end table
2921
2922 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2923 @subsection Advanced features
2924
2925 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2926 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2927 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2928 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2929 special marking characters.
2930
2931 @table @kbd
2932 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2933 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2934 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2935 change all marks in the region.
2936 @end table
2937
2938 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2939 makes use of these features:
2940
2941 @example
2942 @group
2943 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2944 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2945 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2946 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2947 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2948 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2949 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2950 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2951 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2952 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2953 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2954 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2955 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2956 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2957 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2958 @end group
2959 @end example
2960
2961 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2962 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2963 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2964 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2965 empty first field.
2966
2967 @cindex marking characters, tables
2968 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2969 @table @samp
2970 @item !
2971 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2972 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2973 @item ^
2974 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2975 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2976 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2977 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2978 @item _
2979 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2980 @emph{below}.
2981 @item $
2982 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2983 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2984 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2985 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2986 a per-table basis.
2987 @item #
2988 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2989 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2990 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2991 lines will be left alone by this command.
2992 @item *
2993 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2994 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2995 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2996 @item @w{ }
2997 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2998 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2999 or @samp{*}.
3000 @item /
3001 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3002 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3003 @end table
3004
3005 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3006 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3007 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3008 functions.
3009
3010 @example
3011 @group
3012 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3013 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3014 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3015 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3016 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3017 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3018 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3019 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3020 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3021 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3022 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3023 @end group
3024 @end example
3025
3026 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3027 @section Org-Plot
3028 @cindex graph, in tables
3029 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3030 @cindex #+PLOT
3031
3032 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3033 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3034 @uref{http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode}. To see this in action, ensure
3035 that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then
3036 call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3037
3038 @example
3039 @group
3040 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3041 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3042 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3043 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3044 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3045 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3046 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3047 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3048 @end group
3049 @end example
3050
3051 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3052 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3053 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3054 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3055 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3056 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3057
3058 @subsubheading Plot Options
3059
3060 @table @code
3061 @item set
3062 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3063
3064 @item title
3065 Specify the title of the plot.
3066
3067 @item ind
3068 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3069
3070 @item deps
3071 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3072 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3073 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3074 column).
3075
3076 @item type
3077 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3078
3079 @item with
3080 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3081 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3082 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3083
3084 @item file
3085 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3086
3087 @item labels
3088 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3089 if they exist).
3090
3091 @item line
3092 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3093
3094 @item map
3095 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3096 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3097
3098 @item timefmt
3099 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3100 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3101
3102 @item script
3103 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3104 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3105 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3106 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3107 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3108 the data file.
3109 @end table
3110
3111 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3112 @chapter Hyperlinks
3113 @cindex hyperlinks
3114
3115 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3116 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3117
3118 @menu
3119 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3120 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3121 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3122 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3123 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3124 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3125 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3126 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3127 @end menu
3128
3129 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3130 @section Link format
3131 @cindex link format
3132 @cindex format, of links
3133
3134 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3135 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3136
3137 @example
3138 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3139 @end example
3140
3141 @noindent
3142 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3143 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3144 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3145 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3146 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3147 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3148 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3149 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3150 cursor on the link.
3151
3152 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3153 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3154 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3155 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3156 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3157 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3158 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3159
3160 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3161 @section Internal links
3162 @cindex internal links
3163 @cindex links, internal
3164 @cindex targets, for links
3165
3166 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3167 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3168 current file. The most important case is a link like
3169 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3170 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3171 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3172 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3173 in a file.
3174
3175 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3176 lead to a text search in the current file.
3177
3178 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3179 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3180 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3181 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3182 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3183 comment line. For example
3184
3185 @example
3186 # <<My Target>>
3187 @end example
3188
3189 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3190 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3191 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3192 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3193 first headline.}.
3194
3195 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3196 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3197 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3198 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3199 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3200 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3201 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3202
3203 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3204 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3205 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3206 earlier.
3207
3208 @menu
3209 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3210 @end menu
3211
3212 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3213 @subsection Radio targets
3214 @cindex radio targets
3215 @cindex targets, radio
3216 @cindex links, radio targets
3217
3218 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3219 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3220 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3221 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3222 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3223 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3224 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3225 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3226 cursor on or at a target.
3227
3228 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3229 @section External links
3230 @cindex links, external
3231 @cindex external links
3232 @cindex links, external
3233 @cindex Gnus links
3234 @cindex BBDB links
3235 @cindex IRC links
3236 @cindex URL links
3237 @cindex file links
3238 @cindex VM links
3239 @cindex RMAIL links
3240 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3241 @cindex MH-E links
3242 @cindex USENET links
3243 @cindex SHELL links
3244 @cindex Info links
3245 @cindex Elisp links
3246
3247 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3248 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3249 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3250 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3251 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3252
3253 @example
3254 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3255 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3256 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3257 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3258 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3259 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3260 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3261 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3262 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3263 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3264 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3265 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3266 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3267 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3268 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3269 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3270 will be queried to create it.}
3271 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3272 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3273 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3274 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3275 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3276 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3277 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3278 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3279 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3280 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3281 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3282 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3283 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3284 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3285 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3286 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3287 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3288 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3289 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3290 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3291 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3292 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3293 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3294 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3295 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3296 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3297 @end example
3298
3299 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3300
3301 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3302 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3303 format}), for example:
3304
3305 @example
3306 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3307 @end example
3308
3309 @noindent
3310 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3311 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3312 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3313 image,
3314 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3315
3316 @cindex square brackets, around links
3317 @cindex plain text external links
3318 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3319 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3320 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3321 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3322
3323 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3324 @section Handling links
3325 @cindex links, handling
3326
3327 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3328 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3329
3330 @table @kbd
3331 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3332 @cindex storing links
3333 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3334 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3335 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3336 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3337 buffer:
3338
3339 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3340 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3341 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3342 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3343 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3344 timestamp in the headline.}.
3345
3346 @vindex org-id-link-to-org-use-id
3347 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3348 @cindex property, ID
3349 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3350 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3351 @code{org-id-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will
3352 be created and/or used to construct a link@footnote{The library @code{org-id}
3353 must first be loaded, either through @code{org-customize} by enabling
3354 @code{id} in @code{org-modules} , or by adding @code{(require 'org-id)} in
3355 your @file{.emacs}.}. So using this command in Org
3356 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3357 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3358 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3359 to use.
3360
3361 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3362 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3363 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3364 constructed from the author and the subject.
3365
3366 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3367 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3368
3369 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3370 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3371
3372 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
3373 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3374 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3375 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3376 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3377 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3378
3379 @b{Other files}@*
3380 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3381 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3382 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3383 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3384 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3385 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3386 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3387
3388 @b{Agenda view}@*
3389 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3390 entry referenced by the current line.
3391
3392 @c
3393 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3394 @cindex link completion
3395 @cindex completion, of links
3396 @cindex inserting links
3397 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3398 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3399 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3400 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3401 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3402 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3403 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3404 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3405 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3406 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3407 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3408 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3409 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3410 becomes the default description.
3411
3412 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3413 All links stored during the
3414 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3415 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3416
3417 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3418 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3419 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3420 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3421 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3422 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3423 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3424 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3425 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3426 @orgkey C-u C-c C-l
3427 @cindex file name completion
3428 @cindex completion, of file names
3429 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3430 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3431 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3432 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3433 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3434 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3435 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3436 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3437 @c
3438 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3439 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3440 link and description parts of the link.
3441 @c
3442 @cindex following links
3443 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3444 @vindex org-file-apps
3445 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3446 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3447 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3448 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3449 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3450 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3451 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3452 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3453 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3454 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3455 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3456 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3457 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3458 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3459 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3460 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3461
3462 @orgkey @key{RET}
3463 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3464 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3465 the link at point.
3466 @c
3467 @kindex mouse-2
3468 @kindex mouse-1
3469 @item mouse-2
3470 @itemx mouse-1
3471 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3472 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3473 @c
3474 @kindex mouse-3
3475 @item mouse-3
3476 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3477 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3478 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3479 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3480 @c
3481 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3482 @cindex inlining images
3483 @cindex images, inlining
3484 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3485 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3486 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3487 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3488 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3489 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3490 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3491 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3492 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3493 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3494 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3495 @cindex mark ring
3496 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3497 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3498 @c
3499 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3500 @cindex links, returning to
3501 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3502 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3503 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3504 previously recorded positions.
3505 @c
3506 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3507 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3508 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3509 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3510 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3511 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3512 @lisp
3513 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3514 (lambda ()
3515 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3516 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3517 @end lisp
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3521 @section Using links outside Org
3522
3523 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3524 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3525 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3526 yourself):
3527
3528 @lisp
3529 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3530 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3531 @end lisp
3532
3533 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3534 @section Link abbreviations
3535 @cindex link abbreviations
3536 @cindex abbreviation, links
3537
3538 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3539 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3540 abbreviated link looks like this
3541
3542 @example
3543 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3544 @end example
3545
3546 @noindent
3547 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3548 where the tag is optional.
3549 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3550 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3551 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3552 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3553
3554 @smalllisp
3555 @group
3556 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3557 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3558 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3559 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3560 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3561 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3562 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3563 @end group
3564 @end smalllisp
3565
3566 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3567 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3568 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3569 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3570 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3571
3572 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3573 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3574
3575 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3576 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3577
3578 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3579 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3580 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3581 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3582 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3583 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3584 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3585
3586 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3587 can define them in the file with
3588
3589 @cindex #+LINK
3590 @example
3591 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3592 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3593 @end example
3594
3595 @noindent
3596 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3597 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3598 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3599 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3600 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3601
3602 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3603 @section Search options in file links
3604 @cindex search option in file links
3605 @cindex file links, searching
3606
3607 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3608 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3609 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3610 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3611 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3612 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3613 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3614 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3615
3616 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3617 link, together with an explanation:
3618
3619 @example
3620 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3621 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3622 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3623 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3624 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3625 @end example
3626
3627 @table @code
3628 @item 255
3629 Jump to line 255.
3630 @item My Target
3631 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3632 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3633 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3634 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3635 the linked file.
3636 @item *My Target
3637 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3638 @item #my-custom-id
3639 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3640 @item /regexp/
3641 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3642 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3643 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3644 sparse tree with the matches.
3645 @c If the target file is a directory,
3646 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3647 @end table
3648
3649 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3650 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3651 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3652 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3653
3654 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3655 @section Custom Searches
3656 @cindex custom search strings
3657 @cindex search strings, custom
3658
3659 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3660 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3661 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3662 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3663 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3664 citation key.
3665
3666 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3667 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3668 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3669 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3670 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3671 to be added to the hook variables
3672 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3673 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3674 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3675 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3676 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3677
3678 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3679 @chapter TODO items
3680 @cindex TODO items
3681
3682 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3683 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3684 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3685 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3686 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3687 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3688 item emerged is always present.
3689
3690 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3691 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3692 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3693
3694 @menu
3695 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3696 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3697 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3698 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3699 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3700 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3701 @end menu
3702
3703 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3704 @section Basic TODO functionality
3705
3706 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3707 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3708
3709 @example
3710 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3711 @end example
3712
3713 @noindent
3714 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3715
3716 @table @kbd
3717 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3718 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3719 @vindex org-use-fast-todo-selection
3720
3721 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3722
3723 @example
3724 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3725 '--------------------------------'
3726 @end example
3727
3728 If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see @ref{Fast access to TODO
3729 states}), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection
3730 interface; this is the default behavior when
3731 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is @code{non-nil}.
3732
3733 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and agenda
3734 buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3735
3736 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3737 When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using
3738 completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When
3739 @var{org-use-fast-todo-selection} is set to @code{prefix}, use the fast
3740 selection interface.
3741
3742 @kindex S-@key{right}
3743 @kindex S-@key{left}
3744 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3745 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3746 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3747 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3748 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3749 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3750 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3751 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3752 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3753 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3754 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3755 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3756 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3757 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3758 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3759 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3760 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3761 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3762 both un-done and done.
3763 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3764 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3765 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3766 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3767 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3768 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3769 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3770 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3771 @end table
3772
3773 @noindent
3774 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3775 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3776 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3777
3778 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3779 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3780 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3781
3782 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3783 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3784 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3785 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3786 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3787 files.
3788
3789 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3790 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3791
3792 @menu
3793 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3794 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3795 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3796 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3797 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3798 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3799 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3800 @end menu
3801
3802 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3803 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3804 @cindex TODO workflow
3805 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3806
3807 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3808 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3809 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3810 buffer.}:
3811
3812 @lisp
3813 (setq org-todo-keywords
3814 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3815 @end lisp
3816
3817 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3818 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3819 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3820 state.
3821 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3822 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3823 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3824 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3825 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3826 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3827 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3828 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3829 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3830 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3831 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3832
3833 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3834 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3835 @cindex TODO types
3836 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3837 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3838
3839 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3840 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3841 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3842 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3843 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3844 be set up like this:
3845
3846 @lisp
3847 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3848 @end lisp
3849
3850 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3851 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3852 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3853 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3854 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3855 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3856 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3857 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3858 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3859 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3860 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3861 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3862 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3863 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3864
3865 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3866 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3867 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3868
3869 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3870 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3871 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3872 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3873 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3874 like this:
3875
3876 @lisp
3877 (setq org-todo-keywords
3878 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3879 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3880 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3881 @end lisp
3882
3883 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3884 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3885 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3886 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3887 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3888 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3889 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3890
3891 @table @kbd
3892 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3893 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3894 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3895 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3896 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3897 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3898 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3899 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3900 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3901 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3902 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3903 @kindex S-@key{right}
3904 @kindex S-@key{left}
3905 @item S-@key{right}
3906 @itemx S-@key{left}
3907 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3908 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3909 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3910 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3911 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3912 @end table
3913
3914 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3915 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3916
3917 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3918 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3919 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3920 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3921 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3922
3923 @lisp
3924 (setq org-todo-keywords
3925 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3926 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3927 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3928 @end lisp
3929
3930 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3931 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3932 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3933 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3934 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3935 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3936 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3937 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3938
3939 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3940 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3941 @cindex keyword options
3942 @cindex per-file keywords
3943 @cindex #+TODO
3944 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3945 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3946
3947 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3948 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3949 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3950 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3951 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3952 file:
3953
3954 @example
3955 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3956 @end example
3957 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3958 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3959 @example
3960 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3961 @end example
3962
3963 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3964
3965 @example
3966 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3967 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3968 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3969 @end example
3970
3971 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3972 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3973 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3974 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3975
3976 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3977 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3978 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3979 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3980 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3981 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3982 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3983 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3984 for the current buffer.}.
3985
3986 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3987 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3988 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3989
3990 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3991 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3992 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3993 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3994 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3995 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3996 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3997 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3998 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3999
4000 @lisp
4001 @group
4002 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4003 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4004 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4005 @end group
4006 @end lisp
4007
4008 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4009 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4010 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4011 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4012 foreground or a background color.
4013
4014 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4015 @subsection TODO dependencies
4016 @cindex TODO dependencies
4017 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4018
4019 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4020 @cindex property, ORDERED
4021 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4022 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4023 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4024 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4025 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4026 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4027 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4028 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4029 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4030 example:
4031
4032 @example
4033 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4034 ** DONE one
4035 ** TODO two
4036
4037 * Parent
4038 :PROPERTIES:
4039 :ORDERED: t
4040 :END:
4041 ** TODO a
4042 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4043 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4044 @end example
4045
4046 @table @kbd
4047 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4048 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4049 @cindex property, ORDERED
4050 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4051 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4052 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4053 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4054 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4055 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4056 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4057 @end table
4058
4059 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4060 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4061 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4062 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4063
4064 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4065 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4066 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4067 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4068 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4069 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4070
4071 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4072 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4073 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4074
4075 @page
4076 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4077 @section Progress logging
4078 @cindex progress logging
4079 @cindex logging, of progress
4080
4081 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4082 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4083 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a
4084 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4085 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4086 work time}.
4087
4088 @menu
4089 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4090 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4091 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4092 @end menu
4093
4094 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4095 @subsection Closing items
4096
4097 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4098 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4099 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4100
4101 @lisp
4102 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4103 @end lisp
4104
4105 @noindent
4106 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4107 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4108 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4109 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4110 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4111 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4112
4113 @lisp
4114 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4115 @end lisp
4116
4117 @noindent
4118 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4119 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4120
4121 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4122 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4123 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4124 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4125
4126 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4127 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4128 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4129
4130 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4131 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4132 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4133 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4134 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4135 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4136 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4137 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4138 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4139 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4140 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4141 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4142 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4143 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4144 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4145 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4146
4147 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4148 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4149 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4150 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4151 setting
4152
4153 @lisp
4154 (setq org-todo-keywords
4155 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4156 @end lisp
4157
4158 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4159 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4160
4161 @noindent
4162 @vindex org-log-done
4163 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4164 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4165 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4166 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4167 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4168 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4169 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4170 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4171 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4172 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4173 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4174 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4175 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4176 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4177 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4178 configured.
4179
4180 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4181 to a buffer:
4182 @example
4183 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4184 @end example
4185
4186 @cindex property, LOGGING
4187 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4188 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4189 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4190 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4191 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4192 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4193
4194 @example
4195 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4196 :PROPERTIES:
4197 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4198 :END:
4199 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4200 :PROPERTIES:
4201 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4202 :END:
4203 * TODO No logging at all
4204 :PROPERTIES:
4205 :LOGGING: nil
4206 :END:
4207 @end example
4208
4209 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4210 @subsection Tracking your habits
4211 @cindex habits
4212
4213 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4214 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4215
4216 @enumerate
4217 @item
4218 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4219 @code{org-modules}.
4220 @item
4221 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4222 @item
4223 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4224 @item
4225 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4226 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4227 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4228 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4229 @item
4230 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4231 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4232 three days, but at most every two days.
4233 @item
4234 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4235 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4236 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4237 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4238 @end enumerate
4239
4240 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4241 actual habit with some history:
4242
4243 @example
4244 ** TODO Shave
4245 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4246 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4247 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4248 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4249 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4250 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4251 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4252 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4253 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4254 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4255 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4256 :PROPERTIES:
4257 :STYLE: habit
4258 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4259 :END:
4260 @end example
4261
4262 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4263 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4264 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4265 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4266 after four days have elapsed.
4267
4268 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4269 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4270 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4271 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4272
4273 @table @code
4274 @item Blue
4275 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4276 @item Green
4277 If the task could have been done on that day.
4278 @item Yellow
4279 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4280 @item Red
4281 If the task was overdue on that day.
4282 @end table
4283
4284 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4285 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4286 the current day falls in the graph.
4287
4288 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4289 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4290
4291 @table @code
4292 @item org-habit-graph-column
4293 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4294 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4295 titles brief and to the point.
4296 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4297 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4298 @item org-habit-following-days
4299 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4300 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4301 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4302 default.
4303 @end table
4304
4305 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4306 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4307 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4308 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4309
4310 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4311 @section Priorities
4312 @cindex priorities
4313
4314 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4315 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4316 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4317
4318 @example
4319 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4320 @end example
4321
4322 @noindent
4323 @vindex org-priority-faces
4324 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4325 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4326 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4327 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4328 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4329 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4330
4331 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4332 items.
4333
4334 @table @kbd
4335 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
4336 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
4337 @findex org-priority
4338 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4339 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4340 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4341 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4342 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4343 @c
4344 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4345 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4346 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4347 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4348 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4349 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4350 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4351 @end table
4352
4353 @vindex org-highest-priority
4354 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4355 @vindex org-default-priority
4356 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4357 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4358 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4359 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4360 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4361 priority):
4362
4363 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4364 @example
4365 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
4366 @end example
4367
4368 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4369 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4370 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4371 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4372
4373 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4374 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4375 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4376 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4377 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4378 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4379 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4380 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4381 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4382
4383 @example
4384 * Organize Party [33%]
4385 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4386 *** TODO Peter
4387 *** DONE Sarah
4388 ** TODO Buy food
4389 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4390 @end example
4391
4392 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4393 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4394 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4395 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4396 this issue.
4397
4398 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4399 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4400 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4401 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4402 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4403 property.
4404
4405 @example
4406 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4407 :PROPERTIES:
4408 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4409 :END:
4410 @end example
4411
4412 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4413 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4414
4415 @example
4416 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4417 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4418 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4419 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4420
4421 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4422 @end example
4423
4424
4425 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4426 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4427
4428
4429 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4430 @section Checkboxes
4431 @cindex checkboxes
4432
4433 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4434 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4435 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4436 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4437 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4438 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4439 in the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4440 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4441 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4442 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4443
4444 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4445
4446 @example
4447 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4448 - [-] call people [1/3]
4449 - [ ] Peter
4450 - [X] Sarah
4451 - [ ] Sam
4452 - [X] order food
4453 - [ ] think about what music to play
4454 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4455 @end example
4456
4457 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4458 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4459 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4460 checked.
4461
4462 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4463 @cindex checkbox statistics
4464 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4465 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4466 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4467 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4468 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4469 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4470 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4471 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4472 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4473 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4474 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4475 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4476 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4477 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4478 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4479 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4480 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4481 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4482 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4483
4484 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4485 @cindex checkbox blocking
4486 @cindex property, ORDERED
4487 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4488 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4489 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4490
4491 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4492
4493 @table @kbd
4494 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4495 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4496 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4497 one@footnote{@kbd{C-u C-c C-c} on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4498 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4499 considered to be an intermediate state.
4500 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4501 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4502 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4503 intermediate state.
4504 @itemize @minus
4505 @item
4506 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4507 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4508 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4509 @item
4510 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4511 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4512 @item
4513 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4514 @end itemize
4515 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4516 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4517 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4518 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4519 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4520 @cindex property, ORDERED
4521 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4522 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4523 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4524 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4525 for better visibility, customize the variable
4526 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4527 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4528 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4529 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4530 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4531 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4532 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4533 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4534 @end table
4535
4536 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4537 @chapter Tags
4538 @cindex tags
4539 @cindex headline tagging
4540 @cindex matching, tags
4541 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4542
4543 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4544 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4545 support for tags.
4546
4547 @vindex org-tag-faces
4548 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4549 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4550 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4551 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4552 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4553 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4554 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4555 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4556
4557 @menu
4558 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4559 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4560 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4561 @end menu
4562
4563 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4564 @section Tag inheritance
4565 @cindex tag inheritance
4566 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4567 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4568
4569 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4570 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4571 well. For example, in the list
4572
4573 @example
4574 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4575 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4576 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4577 @end example
4578
4579 @noindent
4580 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4581 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4582 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4583 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4584 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4585 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4586 changes in the line.}:
4587
4588 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4589 @example
4590 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4591 @end example
4592
4593 @noindent
4594 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4595 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4596 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4597 To turn it off entirely, use @code{org-use-tag-inheritance}.
4598
4599 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4600 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4601 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4602 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4603 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4604 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4605 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4606 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4607
4608 @vindex org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
4609 Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag,
4610 either in the @code{tags} or @code{tags-todo} agenda types. In other agenda
4611 types, @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} has no effect. Still, you may want to
4612 have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine,
4613 with inherited tags. Set @code{org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance} to control
4614 this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to nil
4615 can really speed up agenda generation.
4616
4617 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4618 @section Setting tags
4619 @cindex setting tags
4620 @cindex tags, setting
4621
4622 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4623 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4624 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4625 also a special command for inserting tags:
4626
4627 @table @kbd
4628 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4629 @cindex completion, of tags
4630 @vindex org-tags-column
4631 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4632 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4633 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4634 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4635 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4636 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4637 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4638 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4639 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4640 @end table
4641
4642 @vindex org-tag-alist
4643 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4644 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4645 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4646 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4647 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4648
4649 @cindex #+TAGS
4650 @example
4651 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4652 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4653 @end example
4654
4655 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4656 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4657 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4658
4659 @example
4660 #+TAGS:
4661 @end example
4662
4663 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4664 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4665 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4666 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4667 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4668 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4669
4670 @example
4671 #+STARTUP: noptag
4672 @end example
4673
4674 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4675 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4676 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4677 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4678 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4679 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4680 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4681 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4682 like:
4683
4684 @lisp
4685 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4686 @end lisp
4687
4688 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4689 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4690
4691 @example
4692 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4693 @end example
4694
4695 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4696 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4697 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4698
4699 @example
4700 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4701 @end example
4702
4703 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4704
4705 @example
4706 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4707 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4708 @end example
4709
4710 @noindent
4711 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4712 braces, as in:
4713
4714 @example
4715 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4716 @end example
4717
4718 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4719 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4720
4721 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4722 these lines to activate any changes.
4723
4724 @noindent
4725 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4726 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4727 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4728 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4729 configuration:
4730
4731 @lisp
4732 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4733 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4734 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4735 (:endgroup . nil)
4736 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4737 @end lisp
4738
4739 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4740 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4741 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4742 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4743 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4744 keys:
4745
4746 @table @kbd
4747 @item a-z...
4748 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4749 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4750 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4751 @kindex @key{TAB}
4752 @item @key{TAB}
4753 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4754 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4755 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4756
4757 @kindex @key{SPC}
4758 @item @key{SPC}
4759 Clear all tags for this line.
4760 @kindex @key{RET}
4761 @item @key{RET}
4762 Accept the modified set.
4763 @item C-g
4764 Abort without installing changes.
4765 @item q
4766 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4767 @item !
4768 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4769 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4770 @item C-c
4771 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4772 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4773 selection window.
4774 @end table
4775
4776 @noindent
4777 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4778 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4779 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4780 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4781 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4782 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4783 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4784 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4785
4786 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4787 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4788 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4789 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4790 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4791 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4792 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4793 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4794 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4795 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4796 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4797
4798 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4799 @section Tag searches
4800 @cindex tag searches
4801 @cindex searching for tags
4802
4803 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4804 information into special lists.
4805
4806 @table @kbd
4807 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4808 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4809 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4810 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4811 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4812 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4813 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4814 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4815 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4816 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4817 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4818 @end table
4819
4820 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4821 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4822 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4823 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4824 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4825 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4826 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4827
4828
4829 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4830 @chapter Properties and columns
4831 @cindex properties
4832
4833 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4834 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4835 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4836
4837 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4838 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4839 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4840 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4841 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4842 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4843 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4844 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4845 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4846
4847 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4848 (@pxref{Column view}).
4849
4850 @menu
4851 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4852 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4853 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4854 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4855 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4856 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4857 @end menu
4858
4859 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4860 @section Property syntax
4861 @cindex property syntax
4862 @cindex drawer, for properties
4863
4864 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4865 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4866 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4867 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4868 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4869
4870 @example
4871 * CD collection
4872 ** Classic
4873 *** Goldberg Variations
4874 :PROPERTIES:
4875 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4876 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4877 :Artist: Glen Gould
4878 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4879 :NDisks: 1
4880 :END:
4881 @end example
4882
4883 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4884 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4885 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4886
4887 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4888 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4889 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4890 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4891 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4892 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4893 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4894
4895 @example
4896 * CD collection
4897 :PROPERTIES:
4898 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4899 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4900 :END:
4901 @end example
4902
4903 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4904 file, use a line like
4905 @cindex property, _ALL
4906 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4907 @example
4908 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4909 @end example
4910
4911 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4912 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4913 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4914 @cindex property, +
4915 @example
4916 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4917 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4918 @end example
4919
4920 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4921 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4922 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4923 @cindex property, +
4924 @example
4925 * CD collection
4926 ** Classic
4927 :PROPERTIES:
4928 :GENRES: Classic
4929 :END:
4930 *** Goldberg Variations
4931 :PROPERTIES:
4932 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4933 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4934 :Artist: Glen Gould
4935 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4936 :NDisks: 1
4937 :GENRES+: Baroque
4938 :END:
4939 @end example
4940 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4941
4942 @vindex org-global-properties
4943 Property values set with the global variable
4944 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4945 Org files.
4946
4947 @noindent
4948 The following commands help to work with properties:
4949
4950 @table @kbd
4951 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4952 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4953 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4954 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4955 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4956 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4957 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4958 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4959 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4960 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4961 information like deadlines.
4962 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4963 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4964 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4965 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4966 can be inserted using completion.
4967 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4968 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4969 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4970 Remove a property from the current entry.
4971 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4972 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4973 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4974 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4975 nearest column format definition.
4976 @end table
4977
4978 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4979 @section Special properties
4980 @cindex properties, special
4981
4982 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4983 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4984 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4985 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4986 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4987 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4988
4989 @cindex property, special, ID
4990 @cindex property, special, TODO
4991 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4992 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4993 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4994 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4995 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4996 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4997 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4998 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4999 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5000 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5001 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5002 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5003 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5004 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5005 @cindex property, special, FILE
5006 @example
5007 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5008 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5009 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5010 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5011 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5012 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5013 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5014 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5015 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5016 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5017 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5018 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5019 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5020 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5021 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5022 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5023 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5024 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5025 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5026 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5027 @end example
5028
5029 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5030 @section Property searches
5031 @cindex properties, searching
5032 @cindex searching, of properties
5033
5034 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5035 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5036 @table @kbd
5037 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
5038 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5039 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5040 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5041 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5042 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5043 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5044 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5045 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5046 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5047 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5048 @end table
5049
5050 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5051 properties}.
5052
5053 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5054 single property:
5055
5056 @table @kbd
5057 @orgkey{C-c / p}
5058 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5059 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5060 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5061 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5062 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5063 @end table
5064
5065 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5066 @section Property Inheritance
5067 @cindex properties, inheritance
5068 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5069
5070 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5071 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5072 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5073 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5074 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5075 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5076 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5077 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5078 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5079 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5080 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5081 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5082 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5083
5084 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5085 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5086
5087 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5088 @table @code
5089 @item COLUMNS
5090 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5091 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5092 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5093 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5094 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5095 @item CATEGORY
5096 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5097 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5098 applies to the entire subtree.
5099 @item ARCHIVE
5100 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5101 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5102 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5103 @item LOGGING
5104 @cindex property, LOGGING
5105 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5106 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5107 @end table
5108
5109 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5110 @section Column view
5111
5112 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5113 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5114 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5115 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5116 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5117 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5118 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5119 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5120 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5121 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5122 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5123 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5124 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5125
5126 @menu
5127 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5128 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5129 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5130 @end menu
5131
5132 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5133 @subsection Defining columns
5134 @cindex column view, for properties
5135 @cindex properties, column view
5136
5137 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5138 done by defining a column format line.
5139
5140 @menu
5141 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5142 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5143 @end menu
5144
5145 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5146 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5147
5148 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5149
5150 @cindex #+COLUMNS
5151 @example
5152 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5153 @end example
5154
5155 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5156 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5157
5158 @example
5159 ** Top node for columns view
5160 :PROPERTIES:
5161 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5162 :END:
5163 @end example
5164
5165 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5166 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5167 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5168 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5169 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5170 deeper part of the tree.
5171
5172 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5173 @subsubsection Column attributes
5174 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5175 definition looks like this:
5176
5177 @example
5178 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5179 @end example
5180
5181 @noindent
5182 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5183 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5184
5185 @example
5186 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5187 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5188 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5189 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5190 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5191 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5192 @r{name is used.}
5193 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5194 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5195 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5196 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5197 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5198 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5199 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5200 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5201 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5202 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5203 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5204 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5205 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5206 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5207 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5208 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5209 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5210 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5211 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5212 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5213 @end example
5214
5215 @noindent
5216 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5217 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5218 same summary information.
5219
5220 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5221 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5222 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5223 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5224 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5225 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5226
5227 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5228 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5229 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5230 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5231 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5232 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5233 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5234 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5235
5236 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5237 values.
5238
5239 @example
5240 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5241 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5242 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5243 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5244 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5245 @end example
5246
5247 @noindent
5248 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5249 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5250 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5251 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5252 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5253 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5254 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5255 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5256 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5257 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5258 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5259 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5260 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5261 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5262 today.
5263
5264 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5265 @subsection Using column view
5266
5267 @table @kbd
5268 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5269 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5270 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5271 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5272 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5273 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5274 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5275 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5276 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5277 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5278 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5279 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5280 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5281 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5282 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5283 Same as @kbd{r}.
5284 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5285 Exit column view.
5286 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5287 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5288 Move through the column view from field to field.
5289 @kindex S-@key{left}
5290 @kindex S-@key{right}
5291 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5292 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5293 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5294 @item 1..9,0
5295 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5296 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5297 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5298 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5299 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5300 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5301 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5302 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5303 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5304 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5305 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5306 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5307 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5308 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5309 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5310 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5311 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5312 current column view.
5313 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5314 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5315 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5316 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5317 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5318 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5319 Delete the current column.
5320 @end table
5321
5322 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5323 @subsection Capturing column view
5324
5325 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5326 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5327 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5328 of this block looks like this:
5329
5330 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5331 @example
5332 * The column view
5333 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5334
5335 #+END:
5336 @end example
5337
5338 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5339
5340 @table @code
5341 @item :id
5342 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5343 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5344 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5345 capture, you can use 4 values:
5346 @cindex property, ID
5347 @example
5348 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5349 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5350 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5351 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5352 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5353 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5354 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5355 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5356 @end example
5357 @item :hlines
5358 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5359 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5360 @item :vlines
5361 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5362 @item :maxlevel
5363 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5364 @item :skip-empty-rows
5365 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5366 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5367
5368 @end table
5369
5370 @noindent
5371 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5372
5373 @table @kbd
5374 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5375 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5376 for the scope or ID of the view.
5377 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5378 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5379 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5380 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5381 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5382 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5383 blocks in a buffer.
5384 @end table
5385
5386 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5387 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5388 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5389 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5390
5391 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5392 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5393 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5394 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5395 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5396 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5397 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5398
5399 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5400 @section The Property API
5401 @cindex properties, API
5402 @cindex API, for properties
5403
5404 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5405 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5406 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5407 property API}.
5408
5409 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5410 @chapter Dates and times
5411 @cindex dates
5412 @cindex times
5413 @cindex timestamp
5414 @cindex date stamp
5415
5416 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5417 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5418 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5419 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5420 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5421 is used in a much wider sense.
5422
5423 @menu
5424 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5425 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5426 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5427 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5428 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5429 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5430 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5431 @end menu
5432
5433
5434 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5435 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5436 @cindex timestamps
5437 @cindex ranges, time
5438 @cindex date stamps
5439 @cindex deadlines
5440 @cindex scheduling
5441
5442 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5443 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5444 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5445 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5446 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5447 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5448 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5449 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5450 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5451 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5452
5453 @table @var
5454 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5455 @cindex timestamp
5456 @cindex appointment
5457 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5458 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5459 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5460 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5461
5462 @example
5463 * Meet Peter at the movies
5464 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5465 * Discussion on climate change
5466 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5467 @end example
5468
5469 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5470 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5471 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5472 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5473 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5474 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5475
5476 @example
5477 * Pick up Sam at school
5478 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5479 @end example
5480
5481 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5482 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5483 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5484 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5485 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5486 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5487 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5488 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5489 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5490 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5491 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5492 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5493 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5494 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5495 example with optional time
5496
5497 @example
5498 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5499 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5500 @end example
5501
5502 @item Time/Date range
5503 @cindex timerange
5504 @cindex date range
5505 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5506 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5507 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5508
5509 @example
5510 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5511 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5512 @end example
5513
5514 @item Inactive timestamp
5515 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5516 @cindex inactive timestamp
5517 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5518 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5519 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5520
5521 @example
5522 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5523 [2006-11-01 Wed]
5524 @end example
5525
5526 @end table
5527
5528 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5529 @section Creating timestamps
5530 @cindex creating timestamps
5531 @cindex timestamps, creating
5532
5533 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5534 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5535 format.
5536
5537 @table @kbd
5538 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5539 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5540 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5541 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5542 succession, a time range is inserted.
5543 @c
5544 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5545 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5546 an agenda entry.
5547 @c
5548 @kindex C-u C-c .
5549 @kindex C-u C-c !
5550 @item C-u C-c .
5551 @itemx C-u C-c !
5552 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5553 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5554 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5555 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5556 @c
5557 @orgkey{C-c C-c}
5558 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5559 @c
5560 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5561 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5562 @c
5563 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5564 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5565 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5566 instead.
5567 @c
5568 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5569 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5570 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5571 @c
5572 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5573 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5574 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5575 @c
5576 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5577 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5578 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5579 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5580 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5581 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5582 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5583 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5584 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5585 @c
5586 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5587 @cindex evaluate time range
5588 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5589 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5590 the following column).
5591 @end table
5592
5593
5594 @menu
5595 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5596 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5597 @end menu
5598
5599 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5600 @subsection The date/time prompt
5601 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5602 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5603
5604 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5605 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5606 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5607 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5608 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5609 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5610 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5611 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5612 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5613 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5614 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5615 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5616 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5617 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5618 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5619 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5620 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5621 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5622
5623 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5624 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5625 in @b{bold}.
5626
5627 @example
5628 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5629 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5630 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5631 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5632 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5633 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5634 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5635 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5636 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5637 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5638 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5639 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5640 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5641 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5642 @end example
5643
5644 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5645 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5646 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5647 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5648 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5649 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5650 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5651
5652 @example
5653 +0 @result{} today
5654 . @result{} today
5655 +4d @result{} four days from today
5656 +4 @result{} same as above
5657 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5658 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5659 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5660 @end example
5661
5662 @vindex parse-time-months
5663 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5664 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5665 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5666 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5667
5668 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5669 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5670 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5671 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5672 read the docstring of the variable
5673 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5674
5675 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5676 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5677 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5678 case, e.g.:
5679
5680 @example
5681 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5682 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5683 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5684 @end example
5685
5686 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5687 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5688 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5689 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5690 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5691 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5692 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5693 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5694 from the minibuffer:
5695
5696 @kindex <
5697 @kindex >
5698 @kindex M-v
5699 @kindex C-v
5700 @kindex mouse-1
5701 @kindex S-@key{right}
5702 @kindex S-@key{left}
5703 @kindex S-@key{down}
5704 @kindex S-@key{up}
5705 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5706 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5707 @kindex @key{RET}
5708 @example
5709 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5710 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5711 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5712 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5713 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5714 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5715 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5716 @end example
5717
5718 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5719 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5720 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5721 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5722 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5723 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5724 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5725
5726 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5727 @subsection Custom time format
5728 @cindex custom date/time format
5729 @cindex time format, custom
5730 @cindex date format, custom
5731
5732 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5733 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5734 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5735 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5736 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5737 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5738 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5739
5740 @table @kbd
5741 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5742 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5743 @end table
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5747 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5748 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5749 following consequences:
5750 @itemize @bullet
5751 @item
5752 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5753 after.
5754 @item
5755 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5756 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5757 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5758 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5759 time will be changed by one minute.
5760 @item
5761 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5762 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5763 @item
5764 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5765 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5766 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5767 @item
5768 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5769 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5770 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5771 @end itemize
5772
5773
5774 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5775 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5776
5777 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5778
5779 @table @var
5780 @item DEADLINE
5781 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5782
5783 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5784 to be finished on that date.
5785
5786 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5787 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5788 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5789 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5790 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5791 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5792
5793 @example
5794 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5795 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5796 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5797 @end example
5798
5799 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5800 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5801 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5802
5803 @item SCHEDULED
5804 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5805
5806 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5807 date.
5808
5809 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5810 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5811 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5812 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5813 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5814 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5815 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5816
5817 @example
5818 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5819 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5820 @end example
5821
5822 @noindent
5823 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5824 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5825 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5826 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5827 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5828 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5829 want to start working on an action item.
5830 @end table
5831
5832 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5833 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5834 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5835 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5836 @c
5837 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5838 @c
5839 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5840 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5841 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5842 sexp entry matches.
5843
5844 @menu
5845 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5846 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5847 @end menu
5848
5849 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5850 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5851
5852 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5853 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5854 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5855 an item:
5856
5857 @table @kbd
5858 @c
5859 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5860 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5861 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5862 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5863 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5864 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5865 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5866 deadline.
5867
5868 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5869 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5870 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5871 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5872 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5873 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5874 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5875 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5876 scheduling time.
5877 @c
5878 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5879 @kindex k a
5880 @kindex k s
5881 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5882 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5883 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5884 schedule the marked item.
5885 @c
5886 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5887 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5888 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5889 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5890 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5891 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5892 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5893 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5894 @c
5895 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5896 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5897 @c
5898 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5899 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5900 @end table
5901
5902 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5903 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5904 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5905 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5906
5907 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5908 @subsection Repeated tasks
5909 @cindex tasks, repeated
5910 @cindex repeated tasks
5911
5912 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5913 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5914 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5915 @example
5916 ** TODO Pay the rent
5917 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5918 @end example
5919 @noindent
5920 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5921 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5922 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5923 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5924 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5925 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5926
5927 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5928 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5929 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5930 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5931 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5932 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5933 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5934 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5935 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5936 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5937 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5938 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5939 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5940 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5941 switch the date like this:
5942
5943 @example
5944 ** TODO Pay the rent
5945 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5946 @end example
5947
5948 @vindex org-log-repeat
5949 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5950 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5951 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5952 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5953 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5954
5955 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5956 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5957 will be visible.
5958
5959 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5960 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5961 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5962 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5963 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5964 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5965 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5966 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5967 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5968
5969 @example
5970 ** TODO Call Father
5971 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5972 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5973 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5974 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5975 and marked it done on Saturday.
5976 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5977 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5978 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5979 today.
5980 @end example
5981
5982 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5983 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5984
5985 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5986 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5987 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5988
5989
5990 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5991 @section Clocking work time
5992 @cindex clocking time
5993 @cindex time clocking
5994
5995 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5996 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
5997 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
5998 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
5999 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6000 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6001 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6002 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6003 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6004
6005 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6006 @lisp
6007 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6008 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6009 @end lisp
6010 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6011 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6012 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6013 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6014 what to do with it.
6015
6016 @menu
6017 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6018 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6019 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6020 @end menu
6021
6022 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6023 @subsection Clocking commands
6024
6025 @table @kbd
6026 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6027 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6028 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6029 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6030 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6031 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6032 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6033 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6034 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6035 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6036 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6037 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6038 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6039 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6040 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6041 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6042 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6043 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6044 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6045 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6046 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6047 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6048 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6049 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6050 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6051 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6052 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6053 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6054 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6055 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6056 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6057 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6058 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6059 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6060 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6061 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6062 @c
6063 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6064 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6065 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6066 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6067 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6068 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6069 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6070 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6071 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6072 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6073 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6074 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6075 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6076 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6077 stopped.
6078 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6079 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6080 @kindex C-c C-y
6081 @kindex C-c C-c
6082 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6083 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6084 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6085 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6086 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6087 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6088 clock duration keeps the same.
6089 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6090 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6091 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6092 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6093 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6094 increased by five minutes.
6095 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6096 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6097 if it is running in this same item.
6098 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6099 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6100 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6101 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6102 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6103 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6104 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6105 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6106 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6107 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6108 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6109 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6110 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6111 @kbd{C-c C-c}.
6112 @end table
6113
6114 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6115 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6116 worked on or closed during a day.
6117
6118 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6119 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6120 modify the window disposition.
6121
6122 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6123 @subsection The clock table
6124 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6125 @cindex report, of clocked time
6126
6127 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6128 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6129 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6130
6131 @table @kbd
6132 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6133 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6134 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6135 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6136 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6137 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6138 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6139 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6140 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6141 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6142 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6143 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6144 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6145 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6146 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6147 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6148 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6149 @end table
6150
6151
6152 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6153 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6154
6155 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6156 @example
6157 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6158 #+END: clocktable
6159 @end example
6160 @noindent
6161 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6162 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6163 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6164 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6165
6166 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6167 be selected:
6168 @example
6169 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6170 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6171 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6172 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6173 file @r{the full current buffer}
6174 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6175 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6176 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6177 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6178 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6179 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6180 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6181 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6182 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6183 @r{these formats:}
6184 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6185 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6186 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6187 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6188 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6189 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6190 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6191 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6192 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6193 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6194 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6195 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6196 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6197 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6198 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6199 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6200 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6201 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6202 @end example
6203
6204 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6205 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6206 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6207 @example
6208 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6209 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6210 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6211 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6212 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6213 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6214 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6215 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6216 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6217 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6218 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6219 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6220 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6221 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6222 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6223 @r{property will get its own column.}
6224 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6225 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6226 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6227 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6228 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6229 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6230 @end example
6231 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6232 day, you could write
6233 @example
6234 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6235 #+END: clocktable
6236 @end example
6237 @noindent
6238 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6239 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6240 only to fit it into the manual.}
6241 @example
6242 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6243 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6244 #+END: clocktable
6245 @end example
6246 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6247 @example
6248 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6249 #+END: clocktable
6250 @end example
6251 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6252 would be
6253 @example
6254 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6255 #+END: clocktable
6256 @end example
6257
6258 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6259 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6260
6261 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6262 @cindex resolve idle time
6263
6264 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6265 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6266 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6267 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6268 applying it to another one.
6269
6270 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6271 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6272 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6273 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6274 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6275 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6276 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6277 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6278 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6279 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6280 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6281 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6282
6283 @table @kbd
6284 @item k
6285 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6286 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6287 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6288 @item K
6289 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6290 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6291 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6292 @item s
6293 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6294 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6295 @item S
6296 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6297 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6298 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6299 @item C
6300 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6301 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6302 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6303 log with an empty entry.
6304 @end table
6305
6306 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6307 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6308 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6309 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6310 the next task you clock in on.
6311
6312 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6313 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6314 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6315 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6316 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6317
6318 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6319 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6320 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6321 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6322 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6323 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6324
6325 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6326 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6327
6328 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6329 @cindex continuous clocking
6330 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6331
6332 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6333 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6334 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6335 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6336
6337 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6338 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6339
6340 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6341 @section Effort estimates
6342 @cindex effort estimates
6343
6344 @cindex property, Effort
6345 @vindex org-effort-property
6346 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6347 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6348 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6349 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6350 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6351 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6352 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6353 for an entry with the following commands:
6354
6355 @table @kbd
6356 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6357 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6358 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6359 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6360 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6361 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6362 @end table
6363
6364 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6365 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6366 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6367 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6368 buffer you can use
6369
6370 @example
6371 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6372 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6373 @end example
6374
6375 @noindent
6376 @vindex org-global-properties
6377 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6378 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6379 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6380 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6381 setup may be advised.
6382
6383 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6384 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6385 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6386 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6387
6388 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6389 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6390 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6391 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6392 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6393 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6394 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6395 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6396 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6397
6398 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6399 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6400 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6401 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6402
6403 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6404 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6405 @cindex relative timer
6406
6407 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6408 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6409 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6410
6411 @table @kbd
6412 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6413 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6414 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6415 restarted.
6416 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6417 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6418 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6419 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6420 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6421 new timer items.
6422 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6423 @kindex C-c C-x ,
6424 @item C-c C-x ,
6425 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6426 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6427 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6428 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6429 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
6430 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6431 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6432 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6433 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6434 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6435 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6436 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6437 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6438 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6439 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6440 not started at exactly the right moment.
6441 @end table
6442
6443 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6444 @section Countdown timer
6445 @cindex Countdown timer
6446 @kindex C-c C-x ;
6447 @kindex ;
6448
6449 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6450 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6451
6452 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6453 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6454 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6455 default value.
6456
6457 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6458 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6459 @cindex capture
6460
6461 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6462 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6463 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6464 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6465 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6466 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6467
6468 @menu
6469 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6470 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6471 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6472 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6473 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6474 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6475 @end menu
6476
6477 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6478 @section Capture
6479 @cindex capture
6480
6481 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6482 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6483 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6484 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6485 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6486
6487 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6488 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6489 @example
6490 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6491 @end example
6492 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6493 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6494 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6495 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6496
6497 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6498 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6499 does enhance it with templates and more.
6500
6501 @menu
6502 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6503 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6504 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6505 @end menu
6506
6507 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6508 @subsection Setting up capture
6509
6510 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6511 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6512 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6513
6514 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6515 @example
6516 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6517 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6518 @end example
6519
6520 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6521 @subsection Using capture
6522
6523 @table @kbd
6524 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6525 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6526 not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates
6527 @cindex date tree
6528 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6529 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6530 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6531 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6532
6533 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6534 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6535 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6536 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6537 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6538
6539 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6540 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6541 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6542 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6543 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6544 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6545 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6546
6547 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6548 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6549
6550 @end table
6551
6552 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6553 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6554 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6555 rather than to the current date.
6556
6557 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6558 prefix commands:
6559
6560 @table @kbd
6561 @orgkey{C-u C-c c}
6562 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6563 template in the usual way.
6564 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6565 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6566 @end table
6567
6568 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6569 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6570 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6571 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6572 @code{nil}.
6573
6574 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6575 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6576
6577 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6578 @subsection Capture templates
6579 @cindex templates, for Capture
6580
6581 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6582 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6583 through the customize interface.
6584
6585 @table @kbd
6586 @orgkey{C-c c C}
6587 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6588 @end table
6589
6590 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6591 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6592 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6593 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6594 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6595 would look like:
6596
6597 @example
6598 (setq org-capture-templates
6599 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6600 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6601 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6602 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6603 @end example
6604
6605 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6606 for you like this:
6607 @example
6608 * TODO
6609 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6610 @end example
6611
6612 @noindent
6613 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6614 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6615 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6616 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6617 place where you started the capture process.
6618
6619 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6620 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6621 like this:
6622
6623 @lisp
6624 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6625 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6626 @end lisp
6627
6628 @menu
6629 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6630 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6631 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6632 @end menu
6633
6634 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6635 @subsubsection Template elements
6636
6637 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6638 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6639
6640 @table @var
6641 @item keys
6642 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6643 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6644 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6645 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6646 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6647 prefix key, for example
6648 @example
6649 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6650 @end example
6651 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6652 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6653
6654 @item description
6655 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6656 selection.
6657
6658 @item type
6659 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6660 @table @code
6661 @item entry
6662 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6663 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6664 @item item
6665 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6666 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6667 @item checkitem
6668 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6669 default template.
6670 @item table-line
6671 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6672 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6673 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6674 @item plain
6675 Text to be inserted as it is.
6676 @end table
6677
6678 @item target
6679 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6680 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6681 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6682 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6683 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6684 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6685 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6686
6687 Valid values are:
6688 @table @code
6689 @item (file "path/to/file")
6690 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6691
6692 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6693 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6694
6695 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6696 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6697
6698 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6699 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6700
6701 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6702 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6703
6704 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6705 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6706
6707 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6708 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6709
6710 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6711 A function to find the right location in the file.
6712
6713 @item (clock)
6714 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6715
6716 @item (function function-finding-location)
6717 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6718 file and location.
6719 @end table
6720
6721 @item template
6722 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6723 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6724 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6725 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6726 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6727 more details.
6728
6729 @item properties
6730 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6731 Recognized properties are:
6732 @table @code
6733 @item :prepend
6734 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6735 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6736 Setting this property will change that.
6737
6738 @item :immediate-finish
6739 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6740 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6741 information that can be added automatically.
6742
6743 @item :empty-lines
6744 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6745 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6746
6747 @item :clock-in
6748 Start the clock in this item.
6749
6750 @item :clock-keep
6751 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6752
6753 @item :clock-resume
6754 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6755 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6756 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6757 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6758
6759 @item :unnarrowed
6760 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6761 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6762
6763 @item :table-line-pos
6764 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6765 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6766 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6767 line.
6768
6769 @item :kill-buffer
6770 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6771 buffer again after capture is completed.
6772 @end table
6773 @end table
6774
6775 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6776 @subsubsection Template expansion
6777
6778 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6779 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6780 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6781
6782 @smallexample
6783 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6784 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6785 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6786 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6787 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6788 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6789 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6790 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6791 @r{region is active.}
6792 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6793 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6794 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6795 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6796 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6797 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6798 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6799 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6800 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6801 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6802 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6803 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6804 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6805 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6806 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6807 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6808 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6809 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6810 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6811 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6812 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6813 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6814 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6815 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6816 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6817 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6818 @end smallexample
6819
6820 @noindent
6821 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6822 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6823 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6824 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6825 similar way.}:
6826
6827 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6828 @smallexample
6829 Link type | Available keywords
6830 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6831 bbdb | %:name %:company
6832 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6833 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6834 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6835 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6836 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6837 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6838 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6839 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6840 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6841 w3, w3m | %:url
6842 info | %:file %:node
6843 calendar | %:date
6844 @end smallexample
6845
6846 @noindent
6847 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6848
6849 @smallexample
6850 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6851 @end smallexample
6852
6853 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6854 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6855
6856 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6857 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6858 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6859 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6860 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6861
6862 @example
6863 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6864 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6865 @end example
6866
6867 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6868 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6869
6870 @example
6871 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6872 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6873 @end example
6874
6875 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6876
6877 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6878 @section Attachments
6879 @cindex attachments
6880
6881 @vindex org-attach-directory
6882 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6883 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6884 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6885 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6886 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6887 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6888 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6889 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6890 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6891 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6892 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6893 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6894 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6895
6896 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6897 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6898 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6899 directory.
6900
6901 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6902
6903 @table @kbd
6904
6905 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6906 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6907 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6908 to select a command:
6909
6910 @table @kbd
6911 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6912 @vindex org-attach-method
6913 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6914 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6915 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6916
6917 @kindex C-c C-a c
6918 @kindex C-c C-a m
6919 @kindex C-c C-a l
6920 @item c/m/l
6921 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6922 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6923
6924 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6925 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6926
6927 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6928 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6929 attachments yourself.
6930
6931 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6932 @vindex org-file-apps
6933 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6934 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6935 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6936 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6937
6938 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6939 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6940
6941 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6942 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6943
6944 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6945 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6946
6947 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6948 Select and delete a single attachment.
6949
6950 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6951 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6952 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6953
6954 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6955 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6956 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6957 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6958
6959 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6960 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6961 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6962 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6963 @end table
6964 @end table
6965
6966 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6967 @section RSS feeds
6968 @cindex RSS feeds
6969 @cindex Atom feeds
6970
6971 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6972 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6973 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6974 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6975 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6976 information. Here is just an example:
6977
6978 @example
6979 (setq org-feed-alist
6980 '(("Slashdot"
6981 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6982 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6983 @end example
6984
6985 @noindent
6986 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6987 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6988 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6989 the following command is used:
6990
6991 @table @kbd
6992 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6993 @item C-c C-x g
6994 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6995 them.
6996 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6997 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6998 @end table
6999
7000 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7001 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7002 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7003 list of drawers in that file:
7004
7005 @example
7006 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7007 @end example
7008
7009 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7010 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7011
7012 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7013 @section Protocols for external access
7014 @cindex protocols, for external access
7015 @cindex emacsserver
7016
7017 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7018 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7019 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7020 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7021 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7022 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7023 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7024 documentation and setup instructions.
7025
7026 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7027 @section Refiling notes
7028 @cindex refiling notes
7029
7030 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7031 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7032 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7033 process, you can use the following special command:
7034
7035 @table @kbd
7036 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7037 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7038 @vindex org-refile-targets
7039 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7040 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7041 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7042 @vindex org-log-refile
7043 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7044 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7045 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7046 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7047 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7048 last subitem.@*
7049 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7050 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7051 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7052 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7053 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7054 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7055 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7056 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7057 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7058 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7059 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7060 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7061 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7062 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7063 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7064 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7065 @item C-2 C-c C-w
7066 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7067 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7068 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7069 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7070 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7071 @end table
7072
7073 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7074 @section Archiving
7075 @cindex archiving
7076
7077 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7078 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7079 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7080 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7081
7082 @table @kbd
7083 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7084 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7085 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7086 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7087 @end table
7088
7089 @menu
7090 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7091 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7092 @end menu
7093
7094 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7095 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7096 @cindex external archiving
7097
7098 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7099 the archive file.
7100
7101 @table @kbd
7102 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7103 @vindex org-archive-location
7104 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7105 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7106 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7107 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7108 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7109 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7110 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7111 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7112 @end table
7113
7114 @cindex archive locations
7115 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7116 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7117 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7118 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7119 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7120 see the documentation string of the variable
7121 @code{org-archive-location}.
7122
7123 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7124 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7125 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7126 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7127 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7128 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7129 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7130 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7131
7132 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
7133 @example
7134 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7135 @end example
7136
7137 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7138 @noindent
7139 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7140 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7141 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7142
7143 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7144 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7145 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7146 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7147 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7148 added.
7149
7150
7151 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7152 @subsection Internal archiving
7153
7154 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7155 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7156
7157 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7158 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7159 @itemize @minus
7160 @item
7161 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7162 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7163 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7164 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7165 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7166 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7167 @item
7168 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7169 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7170 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7171 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7172 @item
7173 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7174 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7175 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7176 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7177 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7178 temporarily included.
7179 @item
7180 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7181 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7182 is. Configure the details using the variable
7183 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7184 @item
7185 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7186 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7187 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7188 @end itemize
7189
7190 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7191
7192 @table @kbd
7193 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7194 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7195 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7196 hidden.
7197 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7198 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7199 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7200 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7201 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7202 level 1 trees will be checked.
7203 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7204 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7205 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7206 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7207 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7208 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7209 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7210 outline.
7211 @end table
7212
7213
7214 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7215 @chapter Agenda views
7216 @cindex agenda views
7217
7218 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7219 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7220 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7221 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7222 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7223
7224 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7225 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7226
7227 @itemize @bullet
7228 @item
7229 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7230 for specific dates,
7231 @item
7232 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7233 action items,
7234 @item
7235 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7236 TODO state associated with them,
7237 @item
7238 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7239 in time-sorted view,
7240 @item
7241 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7242 that contain specified keywords,
7243 @item
7244 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7245 along, and
7246 @item
7247 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7248 views.
7249 @end itemize
7250
7251 @noindent
7252 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7253 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7254 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7255 edit these files remotely.
7256
7257 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7258 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7259 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7260 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7261 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7262 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7263
7264 @menu
7265 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7266 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7267 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7268 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7269 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7270 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7271 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7272 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7273 @end menu
7274
7275 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7276 @section Agenda files
7277 @cindex agenda files
7278 @cindex files for agenda
7279
7280 @vindex org-agenda-files
7281 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7282 files}, the files listed in the variable
7283 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7284 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7285 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7286 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7287 of the list.
7288
7289 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7290 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7291 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7292 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7293 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7294 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7295
7296 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7297 @table @kbd
7298 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7299 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7300 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7301 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7302 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7303 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7304 @kindex C-,
7305 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7306 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7307 @itemx C-,
7308 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7309 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7310 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7311 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7312 buffers.
7313 @end table
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7317 to visit any of them.
7318
7319 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7320 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7321 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7322 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7323 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7324 extended period, use the following commands:
7325
7326 @table @kbd
7327 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7328 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7329 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7330 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7331 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7332 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7333 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7334 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7335 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7336 @end table
7337
7338 @noindent
7339 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7340 the Speedbar frame:
7341 @table @kbd
7342 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7343 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7344 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7345 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7346 effect immediately.
7347 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7348 Lift the restriction.
7349 @end table
7350
7351 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7352 @section The agenda dispatcher
7353 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7354 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7355 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7356 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7357 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7358 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7359 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7360 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7361 @table @kbd
7362 @item a
7363 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7364 @item t @r{/} T
7365 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7366 @item m @r{/} M
7367 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7368 tags and properties}).
7369 @item L
7370 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7371 @item s
7372 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7373 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7374 @item /
7375 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7376 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7377 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7378 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7379 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7380 1.
7381 @item # @r{/} !
7382 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7383 @item <
7384 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7385 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7386 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7387 selecting the command.
7388 @item < <
7389 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7390 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7391 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7392 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7393 character selecting the command.
7394
7395 @item *
7396 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7397 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7398 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7399 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7400 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7401 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7402 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7403 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7404 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7405 @end table
7406
7407 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7408 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7409 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7410 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7411 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7412
7413 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7414 @section The built-in agenda views
7415
7416 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7417
7418 @menu
7419 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7420 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7421 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7422 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7423 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7424 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7425 @end menu
7426
7427 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7428 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7429 @cindex agenda
7430 @cindex weekly agenda
7431 @cindex daily agenda
7432
7433 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7434 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7435
7436 @table @kbd
7437 @cindex org-agenda, command
7438 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7439 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7440 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7441 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7442 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7443 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7444 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7445 @end table
7446
7447 @vindex org-agenda-span
7448 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7449 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7450 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7451 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7452 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7453 @code{year}.
7454
7455 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7456 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7457 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7458 commands}.
7459
7460 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7461 @cindex calendar integration
7462 @cindex diary integration
7463
7464 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7465 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7466 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7467 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7468 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7469 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7470 the diary.
7471
7472 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7473 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7474
7475 @lisp
7476 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7477 @end lisp
7478
7479 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7480 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7481 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7482 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7483 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7484 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7485 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7486 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7487 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7488 between calendar and agenda.
7489
7490 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7491 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7492 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7493 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7494 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7495 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7496 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7497 will be made in the agenda:
7498
7499 @example
7500 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7501 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
7502 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7503 #+CATEGORY: Ann
7504 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7505 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7506 @end example
7507
7508 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7509 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7510 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7511
7512 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7513 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7514 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7515 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7516 following to one of your agenda files:
7517
7518 @example
7519 * Anniversaries
7520 :PROPERTIES:
7521 :CATEGORY: Anniv
7522 :END:
7523 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7524 @end example
7525
7526 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7527 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7528 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7529 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7530 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7531 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7532 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7533
7534 @example
7535 1973-06-22
7536 06-22
7537 1955-08-02 wedding
7538 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7539 @end example
7540
7541 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7542 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7543 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7544 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7545 in an Org or Diary file.
7546
7547 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7548 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7549 @cindex appointment reminders
7550 @cindex appointment
7551 @cindex reminders
7552
7553 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7554 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7555 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7556 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7557 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7558 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7559 docstring for details.
7560
7561 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7562 @subsection The global TODO list
7563 @cindex global TODO list
7564 @cindex TODO list, global
7565
7566 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7567 collected into a single place.
7568
7569 @table @kbd
7570 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7571 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7572 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7573 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7574 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7575 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7576 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7577 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7578 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7579 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7580 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7581 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7582 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7583 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7584 @kindex r
7585 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7586 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7587 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7588 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7589 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7590 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7591 @end table
7592
7593 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7594 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7595 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7596
7597 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7598 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7599 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7600 it more compact:
7601 @itemize @minus
7602 @item
7603 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7604 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7605 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7606 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7607 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7608 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7609 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7610 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7611 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7612 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7613 TODO list.
7614 @item
7615 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7616 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7617 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7618 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7619 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7620 @end itemize
7621
7622 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7623 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7624 @cindex matching, of tags
7625 @cindex matching, of properties
7626 @cindex tags view
7627 @cindex match view
7628
7629 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7630 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7631 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7632 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7633 m}.
7634
7635 @table @kbd
7636 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7637 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7638 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7639 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7640 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7641 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7642 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7643 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7644 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7645 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7646 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7647 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7648 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7649 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7650 @ref{Tag searches}.
7651 @end table
7652
7653 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7654 commands}.
7655
7656 @subsubheading Match syntax
7657
7658 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7659 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7660 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7661 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7662 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7663 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7664 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7665 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7666 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7667
7668 @table @samp
7669 @item +work-boss
7670 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7671 @samp{:boss:}.
7672 @item work|laptop
7673 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7674 @item work|laptop+night
7675 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7676 @samp{:night:}.
7677 @end table
7678
7679 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7680 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7681 braces. For example,
7682 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7683 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7684
7685 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7686 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7687 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7688 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7689 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7690 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7691 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7692 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7693 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7694 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7695 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7696 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7697 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7698 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7699 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7700 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7701
7702 Here are more examples:
7703 @table @samp
7704 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7705 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7706 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7707 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7708 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7709 @end table
7710
7711 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7712 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7713
7714 @example
7715 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7716 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7717 @end example
7718
7719 @noindent
7720 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7721 @itemize @minus
7722 @item
7723 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7724 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7725 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7726 @item
7727 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7728 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7729 @item
7730 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7731 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7732 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7733 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7734 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7735 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7736 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7737 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7738 respectively, can be used.
7739 @item
7740 If the comparison value is enclosed
7741 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7742 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7743 match.
7744 @end itemize
7745
7746 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7747 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7748 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7749 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7750 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7751 on or after October 11, 2008.
7752
7753 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7754 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7755 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7756 again.
7757
7758 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7759 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7760 inheritance}, for details.
7761
7762 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7763 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7764 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7765 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7766 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7767 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7768 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7769 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7770 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7771 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7772 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7773 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7774
7775 @table @samp
7776 @item work/WAITING
7777 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7778 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7779 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7780 nor @samp{NEXT}
7781 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7782 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7783 @samp{NEXT}.
7784 @end table
7785
7786 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7787 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7788 @cindex timeline, single file
7789 @cindex time-sorted view
7790
7791 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7792 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7793 to give an overview over events in a project.
7794
7795 @table @kbd
7796 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7797 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7798 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7799 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7800 @end table
7801
7802 @noindent
7803 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7804 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7805
7806 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7807 @subsection Search view
7808 @cindex search view
7809 @cindex text search
7810 @cindex searching, for text
7811
7812 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7813 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7814
7815 @table @kbd
7816 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7817 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7818 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7819 @end table
7820 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7821 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7822 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7823 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7824 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7825 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7826 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7827 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7828 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7829 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7830 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7831
7832 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7833 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7834 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7835
7836 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7837 @subsection Stuck projects
7838 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7839
7840 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7841 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7842 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7843 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7844 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7845 projects and define next actions for them.
7846
7847 @table @kbd
7848 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7849 List projects that are stuck.
7850 @kindex C-c a !
7851 @item C-c a !
7852 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7853 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7854 project is and how to find it.
7855 @end table
7856
7857 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7858 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7859 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7860 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7861
7862 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7863 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7864 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7865 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7866 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7867 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7868 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7869 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7870 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7871 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7872 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7873 correct customization for this is
7874
7875 @lisp
7876 (setq org-stuck-projects
7877 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7878 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7879 @end lisp
7880
7881 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7882 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7883
7884 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7885 @section Presentation and sorting
7886 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7887
7888 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7889 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7890 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7891 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7892 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7893 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7894 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7895 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7896 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7897 associated with the item.
7898
7899 @menu
7900 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7901 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7902 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7903 @end menu
7904
7905 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7906 @subsection Categories
7907
7908 @cindex category
7909 @cindex #+CATEGORY
7910 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7911 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7912 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7913 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7914 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7915 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7916 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7917 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7918 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7919 property.}:
7920
7921 @example
7922 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7923 @end example
7924
7925 @noindent
7926 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7927 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7928 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7929 special category you want to apply as the value.
7930
7931 @noindent
7932 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7933 longer than 10 characters.
7934
7935 @noindent
7936 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7937 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7938
7939 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7940 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7941 @cindex time-of-day specification
7942
7943 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7944 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7945 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7946 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7947 @c
7948 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7949
7950 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7951 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7952 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7953 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7954
7955 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7956 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7957 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7958
7959 @example
7960 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7961 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7962 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7963 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7964 @end example
7965
7966 @cindex time grid
7967 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7968 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7969
7970 @example
7971 8:00...... ------------------
7972 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7973 10:00...... ------------------
7974 12:00...... ------------------
7975 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7976 14:00...... ------------------
7977 16:00...... ------------------
7978 18:00...... ------------------
7979 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7980 20:00...... ------------------
7981 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7982 @end example
7983
7984 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7985 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7986 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7987 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7988 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7989
7990 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7991 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7992 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7993 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7994 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7995 done depends on the type of view.
7996 @itemize @bullet
7997 @item
7998 @vindex org-agenda-files
7999 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8000 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8001 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8002 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8003 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8004 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8005 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8006 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8007 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8008 @item
8009 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8010 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8011 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8012 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8013 or scheduled date.
8014 @item
8015 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8016 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8017 @end itemize
8018
8019 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8020 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8021 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8022 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8023
8024 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8025 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8026 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8027
8028 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8029 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8030 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8031 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8032 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8033 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8034
8035 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8036 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8037
8038 @table @kbd
8039 @tsubheading{Motion}
8040 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8041 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8042 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8043 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8044 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8045 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8046 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8047 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8048 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8049 outline, not only the heading.
8050 @c
8051 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8052 Display original location and recenter that window.
8053 @c
8054 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8055 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8056 @c
8057 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8058 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8059 @c
8060 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8061 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8062 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8063 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8064 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8065 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8066 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8067 @c
8068 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8069 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8070 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8071 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8072 previously used indirect buffer.
8073
8074 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8075 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8076 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8077 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8078
8079 @tsubheading{Change display}
8080 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8081 @kindex A
8082 @item A
8083 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8084 @c
8085 @kindex o
8086 @item o
8087 Delete other windows.
8088 @c
8089 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8090 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8091 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8092 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8093 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8094 @vindex org-agenda-span
8095 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8096 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8097 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8098 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8099 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8100 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8101 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8102 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8103 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8104 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8105 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8106 @c
8107 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8108 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8109 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8110 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8111 @c
8112 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8113 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8114 @c
8115 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8116 Go to today.
8117 @c
8118 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8119 Prompt for a date and go there.
8120 @c
8121 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8122 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8123 @c
8124 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8125 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8126 @c
8127 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8128 @kindex v L
8129 @vindex org-log-done
8130 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8131 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8132 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8133 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8134 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8135 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8136 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8137 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8138 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8139 @c
8140 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8141 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8142 agenda and timeline views.
8143 @c
8144 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8145 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8146 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8147 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8148 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8149 press @kbd{v a} again.
8150 @c
8151 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8152 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8153 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8154 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8155 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8156 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8157 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8158 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8159 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8160 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8161 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8162 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8163 @c
8164 @orgkey{v c}
8165 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8166 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8167 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8168 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8169 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8170 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8171 mode.
8172 @c
8173 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8174 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8175 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8176 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8177 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8178 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8179 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8180 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8181 @c
8182 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8183 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8184 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8185 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8186 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8187 @c
8188 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8189 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8190 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8191 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8192 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8193 keyword.
8194 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8195 Same as @kbd{r}.
8196 @c
8197 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8198 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8199 IDs.
8200 @c
8201 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8202 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8203 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8204 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8205 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8206 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8207 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8208 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8209
8210 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8211 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8212 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8213
8214 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8215 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8216 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8217 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8218 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8219 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8220
8221 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8222 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8223
8224 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8225 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8226 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8227 (see below.)
8228
8229 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8230 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8231 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8232 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8233 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8234 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8235 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8236 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8237 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8238 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8239 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8240
8241 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8242 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8243 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8244 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8245 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8246 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8247 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8248 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8249 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8250 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8251
8252 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8253 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8254 efforts globally, for example
8255 @lisp
8256 (setq org-global-properties
8257 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8258 @end lisp
8259 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8260 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8261 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8262 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8263 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0--9 are not used
8264 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8265 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8266 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8267 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8268 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8269
8270 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8271 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8272 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8273 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8274 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8275 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8276 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8277 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8278 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8279
8280 @lisp
8281 @group
8282 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8283 (and (cond
8284 ((string= tag "Net")
8285 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8286 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8287 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8288 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8289 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8290 (concat "-" tag)))
8291
8292 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8293 @end group
8294 @end lisp
8295
8296 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8297 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8298 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8299 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8300 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8301
8302 @c
8303 @kindex [
8304 @kindex ]
8305 @kindex @{
8306 @kindex @}
8307 @item [ ] @{ @}
8308 @table @i
8309 @item @r{in} search view
8310 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8311 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8312 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8313 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8314 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8315 selected.
8316 @end table
8317
8318 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8319 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8320
8321 @item 0--9
8322 Digit argument.
8323 @c
8324 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8325 @cindex remote editing, undo
8326 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8327 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8328 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8329 @c
8330 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8331 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8332 original org file.
8333 @c
8334 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8335 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8336 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8337 @c
8338 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8339 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8340 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8341 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8342 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8343 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8344 @c
8345 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8346 Refile the entry at point.
8347 @c
8348 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8349 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8350 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8351 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8352 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8353 @c
8354 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8355 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8356 @c
8357 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8358 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8359 sibling}.
8360 @c
8361 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8362 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8363 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8364 different file.
8365 @c
8366 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8367 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8368 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8369 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8370 tags of a headline occasionally.
8371 @c
8372 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8373 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8374 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8375 @c
8376 @kindex ,
8377 @item ,
8378 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8379 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8380 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8381 @c
8382 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8383 Display weighted priority of current item.
8384 @c
8385 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8386 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8387 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8388 key for this.
8389 @c
8390 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8391 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8392 @c
8393 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8394 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8395 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8396 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8397 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8398 @c
8399 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8400 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8401 @c
8402 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8403 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8404 @c
8405 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8406 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8407 @c
8408 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8409 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8410 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8411 it to today.@*
8412 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8413 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8414 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8415 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8416 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8417 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8418 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8419 @c
8420 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8421 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8422 into the past.
8423 @c
8424 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8425 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8426 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8427 @c
8428 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8429 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8430 is stopped first.
8431 @c
8432 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8433 Stop the previously started clock.
8434 @c
8435 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8436 Cancel the currently running clock.
8437 @c
8438 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8439 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8440 @c
8441 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8442 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8443 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8444 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8445 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8446 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8447
8448 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8449 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8450 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8451 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8452
8453 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8454 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8455 successive entries.
8456 @c
8457 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8458 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8459 @c
8460 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8461 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8462 @c
8463 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8464 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8465 @c
8466 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8467 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8468 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8469 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8470 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8471 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8472 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8473
8474 @example
8475 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8476 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8477 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8478 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8479 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8480 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8481 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8482 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8483 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8484 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8485 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8486 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8487 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8488 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8489 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8490 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8491 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8492 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8493 @r{entries to web.}
8494 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8495 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8496 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8497 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8498 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8499 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8500 @r{ (save-excursion}
8501 @r{ (save-restriction}
8502 @r{ (widen)}
8503 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8504 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8505 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8506 @end example
8507
8508
8509 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8510 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8511
8512 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8513 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8514 @c
8515 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8516 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8517 date at the cursor.
8518 @c
8519 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8520 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8521 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8522 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8523 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8524 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8525 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8526 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8527 you can add the entry.
8528
8529 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8530 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8531 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8532 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8533 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8534 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8535 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8536 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8537 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8538 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8539 @c
8540 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8541 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8542 @c
8543 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8544 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8545 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8546 @c
8547 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8548 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8549 calendars.
8550 @c
8551 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8552 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8553
8554 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8555 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8556 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8557
8558 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8559 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8560 @cindex exporting agenda views
8561 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8562 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8563 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8564 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8565 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8566 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8567 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8568 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8569 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8570
8571 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8572 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8573 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8574 @c
8575 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8576 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8577 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8578 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8579 visit Org files will not be removed.
8580 @end table
8581
8582
8583 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8584 @section Custom agenda views
8585 @cindex custom agenda views
8586 @cindex agenda views, custom
8587
8588 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8589 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8590 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8591 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8592
8593 @menu
8594 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8595 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8596 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8597 @end menu
8598
8599 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8600 @subsection Storing searches
8601
8602 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8603 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8604 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8605 buffer).
8606 @kindex C-c a C
8607 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8608 @cindex agenda views, main example
8609 @cindex tags, as an agenda view
8610 @cindex todo, as an agenda view
8611 @cindex tags-todo
8612 @cindex todo-tree
8613 @cindex occur-tree
8614 @cindex tags-tree
8615
8616 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8617 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8618 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8619 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8620 types:
8621
8622 @lisp
8623 @group
8624 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8625 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8626 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8627 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8628 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8629 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8630 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8631 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8632 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8633 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8634 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8635 @end group
8636 @end lisp
8637
8638 @noindent
8639 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8640 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8641 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8642 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8643 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8644 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8645 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8646 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8647 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8648 therefore define:
8649
8650 @table @kbd
8651 @item C-c a w
8652 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8653 keyword
8654 @item C-c a W
8655 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8656 results as a sparse tree
8657 @item C-c a u
8658 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8659 @samp{:urgent:}
8660 @item C-c a v
8661 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8662 headlines that are also TODO items
8663 @item C-c a U
8664 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8665 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8666 @item C-c a f
8667 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8668 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8669 @item C-c a h
8670 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8671 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8672 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8673 @end table
8674
8675 Note that the @code{*-tree} agenda views need to be called from an
8676 Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only.
8677
8678 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8679 @subsection Block agenda
8680 @cindex block agenda
8681 @cindex agenda, with block views
8682
8683 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8684 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8685 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8686 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8687 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8688 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8689 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8690
8691 @lisp
8692 @group
8693 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8694 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8695 ((agenda "")
8696 (tags-todo "home")
8697 (tags "garden")))
8698 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8699 ((agenda "")
8700 (tags-todo "work")
8701 (tags "office")))))
8702 @end group
8703 @end lisp
8704
8705 @noindent
8706 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8707 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8708 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8709 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8710 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8711
8712 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8713 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8714 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8715
8716 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8717 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8718 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8719 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8720 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8721 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8722 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8723
8724 @lisp
8725 @group
8726 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8727 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8728 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8729 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8730 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8731 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8732 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8733 ("N" search ""
8734 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8735 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8736 @end group
8737 @end lisp
8738
8739 @noindent
8740 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8741 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8742 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8743 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8744 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8745 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8746 to only a single file.
8747
8748 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8749 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8750 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8751 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8752 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8753 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8754 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8755 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8756 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8757 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8758 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8759
8760 @lisp
8761 @group
8762 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8763 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8764 ((agenda)
8765 (tags-todo "home")
8766 (tags "garden"
8767 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8768 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8769 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8770 ((agenda)
8771 (tags-todo "work")
8772 (tags "office")))))
8773 @end group
8774 @end lisp
8775
8776 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8777 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8778 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8779 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8780 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8781 yourself.
8782
8783 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8784 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8785 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8786 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8787 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8788 like this:
8789
8790 @example
8791 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8792 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8793 @end example
8794
8795 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8796 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8797
8798 @example
8799 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8800 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8801 @end example
8802
8803 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8804
8805 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8806 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8807 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8808
8809 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8810 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8811 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8812 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8813 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8814 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8815 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8816
8817 @table @kbd
8818 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8819 @cindex exporting agenda views
8820 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8821 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8822 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8823 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8824 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8825 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8826 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8827 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8828
8829 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8830 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8831 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8832 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8833 @lisp
8834 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8835 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8836 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8837 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8838 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8839 @end lisp
8840 @end table
8841
8842 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8843 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8844 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8845 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8846 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8847 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8848 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8849 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8850 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8851 or absolute.
8852
8853 @lisp
8854 @group
8855 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8856 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8857 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8858 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8859 ((agenda "")
8860 (tags-todo "home")
8861 (tags "garden"))
8862 nil
8863 ("~/views/home.html"))
8864 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8865 ((agenda)
8866 (tags-todo "work")
8867 (tags "office"))
8868 nil
8869 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8870 @end group
8871 @end lisp
8872
8873 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8874 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8875 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8876 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8877 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8878 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8879 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8880 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8881
8882 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8883 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8884 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8885 files in one step:
8886
8887 @table @kbd
8888 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8889 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8890 them.
8891 @end table
8892
8893 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8894 set options for the export commands. For example:
8895
8896 @lisp
8897 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8898 '(("X" agenda ""
8899 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8900 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8901 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8902 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8903 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8904 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8905 @end lisp
8906
8907 @noindent
8908 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8909 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8910 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8911 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8912 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8913 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8914 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8915 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8916 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8917
8918 @noindent
8919 From the command line you may also use
8920 @example
8921 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8922 @end example
8923 @noindent
8924 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8925 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8926 @example
8927 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8928 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8929 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8930 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8931 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8932 -kill
8933 @end example
8934 @noindent
8935 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8936 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8937 extent.
8938
8939 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8940 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8941 more information.
8942
8943
8944 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8945 @section Using column view in the agenda
8946 @cindex column view, in agenda
8947 @cindex agenda, column view
8948
8949 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8950 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8951 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8952 collected by certain criteria.
8953
8954 @table @kbd
8955 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8956 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8957 @end table
8958
8959 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8960 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8961 This causes the following issues:
8962
8963 @enumerate
8964 @item
8965 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8966 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8967 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8968 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8969 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8970 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8971 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8972 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8973 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8974 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8975 @item
8976 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8977 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8978 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8979 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8980 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8981 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8982 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8983 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8984 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8985 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8986 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8987 some values will count double.
8988 @item
8989 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8990 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8991 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8992 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8993 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8994 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8995 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8996 the agenda).
8997
8998 @item
8999 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9000 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9001 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9002 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9003 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9004 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9005 @end enumerate
9006
9007
9008 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9009 @chapter Markup for rich export
9010
9011 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9012 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9013 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9014 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9015 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9016
9017 @menu
9018 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9019 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9020 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9021 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9022 * Index entries:: Making an index
9023 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9024 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9025 @end menu
9026
9027 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9028 @section Structural markup elements
9029
9030 @menu
9031 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9032 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9033 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9034 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9035 * Lists:: Lists
9036 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9037 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9038 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9039 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9040 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9041 @end menu
9042
9043 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9044 @subheading Document title
9045 @cindex document title, markup rules
9046
9047 @noindent
9048 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9049
9050 @cindex #+TITLE
9051 @example
9052 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9053 @end example
9054
9055 @noindent
9056 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9057 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9058 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9059 title will be the file name without extension.
9060
9061 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9062 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9063 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9064 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9065
9066 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9067 @subheading Headings and sections
9068 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9069
9070 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9071 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9072 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9073 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9074 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9075 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9076 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9077 per-file basis with a line
9078
9079 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9080 @example
9081 #+OPTIONS: H:4
9082 @end example
9083
9084 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9085 @subheading Table of contents
9086 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9087
9088 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9089 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9090 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9091 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9092 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9093 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9094 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9095 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9096
9097 @example
9098 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9099 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9100 @end example
9101
9102 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9103 @subheading Text before the first headline
9104 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9105 @cindex #+TEXT
9106
9107 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9108 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9109 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9110 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9111
9112 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9113 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9114 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9115 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9116 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9117 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9118
9119 @noindent
9120 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9121 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9122
9123 @example
9124 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
9125 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9126 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9127 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9128 @end example
9129
9130 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9131 @subheading Lists
9132 @cindex lists, markup rules
9133
9134 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9135 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9136 description lists.
9137
9138 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9139 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9140 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9141
9142 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9143 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9144
9145 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9146 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9147
9148 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9149 @example
9150 #+BEGIN_VERSE
9151 Great clouds overhead
9152 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9153 Snow covers Emacs
9154
9155 -- AlexSchroeder
9156 #+END_VERSE
9157 @end example
9158
9159 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9160 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9161 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9162
9163 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9164 @example
9165 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9166 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9167 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9168 #+END_QUOTE
9169 @end example
9170
9171 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9172 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9173 @example
9174 #+BEGIN_CENTER
9175 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9176 but not any simpler
9177 #+END_CENTER
9178 @end example
9179
9180
9181 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9182 @subheading Footnote markup
9183 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9184 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9185
9186 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9187 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9188 multiple footnotes side by side.
9189
9190 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9191 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9192
9193 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9194 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9195 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9196 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9197 @cindex code text, markup rules
9198 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9199 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9200 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9201 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9202 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9203
9204 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9205 @subheading Horizontal rules
9206 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9207 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9208 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9209
9210 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9211 @subheading Comment lines
9212 @cindex comment lines
9213 @cindex exporting, not
9214 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9215
9216 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9217 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9218 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9219 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9220 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9221
9222 @table @kbd
9223 @kindex C-c ;
9224 @item C-c ;
9225 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9226 @end table
9227
9228
9229 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9230 @section Images and Tables
9231
9232 @cindex tables, markup rules
9233 @cindex #+CAPTION
9234 @cindex #+LABEL
9235 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9236 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9237 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9238 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9239 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9240 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9241
9242 @example
9243 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9244 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9245 | ... | ...|
9246 |-----|----|
9247 @end example
9248
9249 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9250 @example
9251 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9252 @end example
9253
9254 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9255 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9256 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9257 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9258 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9259 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9260 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9261
9262 @example
9263 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9264 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9265 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9266 @end example
9267
9268 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9269 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9270 information.
9271
9272 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9273
9274 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9275 @section Literal examples
9276 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9277 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9278
9279 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9280 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9281 for source code and similar examples.
9282 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9283
9284 @example
9285 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9286 Some example from a text file.
9287 #+END_EXAMPLE
9288 @end example
9289
9290 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9291 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9292 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9293 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9294 whitespace before the colon:
9295
9296 @example
9297 Here is an example
9298 : Some example from a text file.
9299 @end example
9300
9301 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9302 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9303 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9304 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9305 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9306 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9307 achieved using either the listings or the
9308 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9309 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9310 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9311 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9312 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9313 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9314 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9315 blocks.
9316 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
9317
9318 @example
9319 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9320 (defun org-xor (a b)
9321 "Exclusive or."
9322 (if a (not b) b))
9323 #+END_SRC
9324 @end example
9325
9326 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9327 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9328 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9329 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9330 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9331 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9332 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9333 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9334 cool.
9335
9336 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9337 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9338 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9339 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9340 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9341 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9342 Here is an example:
9343
9344 @example
9345 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9346 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9347 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9348 #+END_SRC
9349 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9350 jumps to point-min.
9351 @end example
9352
9353 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9354 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9355 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9356 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9357
9358 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9359 areas in HTML export}).
9360
9361 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9362 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9363 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9364
9365 @table @kbd
9366 @kindex C-c '
9367 @item C-c '
9368 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9369 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9370 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9371 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9372 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9373 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9374 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9375 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9376 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9377 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9378 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9379 will create a new fixed-width region.
9380 @kindex C-c l
9381 @item C-c l
9382 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9383 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9384 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9385 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9386 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9387 @end table
9388
9389
9390 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9391 @section Include files
9392 @cindex include files, markup rules
9393
9394 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9395 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9396 @cindex #+INCLUDE
9397
9398 @example
9399 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9400 @end example
9401 @noindent
9402 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9403 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9404 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9405 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9406 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9407 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9408 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9409 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9410 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9411 use
9412
9413 @example
9414 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9415 @end example
9416
9417 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9418 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9419 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9420 obvious defaults.
9421
9422 @example
9423 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9424 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9425 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9426 @end example
9427
9428 @table @kbd
9429 @kindex C-c '
9430 @item C-c '
9431 Visit the include file at point.
9432 @end table
9433
9434 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9435 @section Index entries
9436 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9437
9438 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9439 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9440 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9441 an index} for more information.
9442
9443 @example
9444 * Curriculum Vitae
9445 #+INDEX: CV
9446 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9447 @end example
9448
9449
9450
9451
9452 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9453 @section Macro replacement
9454 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9455 @cindex #+MACRO
9456
9457 You can define text snippets with
9458
9459 @example
9460 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9461 @end example
9462
9463 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9464 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9465 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9466 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9467 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9468 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9469 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9470 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9471 @code{format-time-string}.
9472
9473 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9474 construct complex HTML code.
9475
9476
9477 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9478 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9479 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9480 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9481
9482 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9483 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9484 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9485 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9486 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9487 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9488 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9489 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9490 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9491
9492 @menu
9493 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9494 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9495 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9496 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9497 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9498 @end menu
9499
9500 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9501 @subsection Special symbols
9502 @cindex math symbols
9503 @cindex special symbols
9504 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9505 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9506 @cindex HTML entities
9507 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9508
9509 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9510 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9511 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9512 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9513 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9514 delimiters, for example:
9515
9516 @example
9517 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9518 @end example
9519
9520 @vindex org-entities
9521 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9522 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9523 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9524 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
9525 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9526 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9527
9528 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9529 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9530 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9531 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9532 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9533
9534 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9535 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9536 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9537 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9538
9539 @table @kbd
9540 @kindex C-c C-x \
9541 @item C-c C-x \
9542 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9543 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9544 for display purposes only.
9545 @end table
9546
9547 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9548 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9549 @cindex subscript
9550 @cindex superscript
9551
9552 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9553 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9554 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9555 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9556 with curly braces. For example
9557
9558 @example
9559 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9560 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9561 @end example
9562
9563 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9564 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9565 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9566 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9567 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9568 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9569 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9570
9571 @example
9572 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
9573 @end example
9574
9575 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9576 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9577
9578 @table @kbd
9579 @kindex C-c C-x \
9580 @item C-c C-x \
9581 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9582 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9583 @end table
9584
9585 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9586 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9587 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9588
9589 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9590 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9591 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9592 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9593 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9594 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9595 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9596 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9597 @file{MathJax} on your own
9598 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9599 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9600 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9601 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9602 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9603 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9604 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9605 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9606 DocBook documents.
9607
9608 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9609 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9610 @itemize @bullet
9611 @item
9612 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9613 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9614 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9615 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9616 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9617 @item
9618 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9619 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9620 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9621 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9622 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9623 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9624 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9625 @end itemize
9626
9627 @noindent For example:
9628
9629 @example
9630 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9631 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9632 \end@{equation@} % etc
9633
9634 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9635 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9636 @end example
9637
9638 @noindent
9639 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9640 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9641 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9642 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9643
9644 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9645 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9646 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9647 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9648 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9649 of these lines:
9650
9651 @example
9652 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9653 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9654 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9655 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9656 @end example
9657
9658 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9659 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9660 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9661
9662 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9663 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9664
9665 @table @kbd
9666 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
9667 @item C-c C-x C-l
9668 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9669 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9670 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9671 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9672 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9673 process the entire buffer.
9674 @kindex C-c C-c
9675 @item C-c C-c
9676 Remove the overlay preview images.
9677 @end table
9678
9679 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9680 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9681 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9682 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9683 preview images.
9684
9685 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9686 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9687 @cindex CD@LaTeX{}
9688
9689 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9690 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9691 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9692 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9693 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9694 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9695 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9696 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9697 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9698 Org files with
9699
9700 @lisp
9701 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9702 @end lisp
9703
9704 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9705 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9706 @itemize @bullet
9707 @kindex C-c @{
9708 @item
9709 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9710 @item
9711 @kindex @key{TAB}
9712 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9713 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9714 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9715 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9716 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9717 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9718 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9719 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9720 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9721 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9722 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9723 @item
9724 @kindex _
9725 @kindex ^
9726 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9727 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9728 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9729 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9730 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9731 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9732 @item
9733 @kindex `
9734 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9735 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9736 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9737 @item
9738 @kindex '
9739 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9740 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9741 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9742 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9743 is normal.
9744 @end itemize
9745
9746 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9747 @chapter Exporting
9748 @cindex exporting
9749
9750 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9751 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9752 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9753 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9754 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9755 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9756 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9757 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9758 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9759 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9760 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9761 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9762 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9763 these different formats.
9764
9765 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9766 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9767
9768 @menu
9769 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9770 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9771 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9772 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9773 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9774 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9775 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9776 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9777 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9778 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9779 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9780 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9781 @end menu
9782
9783 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9784 @section Selective export
9785 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9786
9787 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9788 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9789 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9790 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9791 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9792 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9793 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9794
9795 @enumerate
9796 @item
9797 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9798 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9799 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9800 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9801
9802 @item
9803 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9804 export.
9805
9806 @item
9807 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9808 be removed from the export buffer.
9809 @end enumerate
9810
9811 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9812 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9813 variable for more information.
9814
9815 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9816 @section Export options
9817 @cindex options, for export
9818
9819 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9820 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9821 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9822 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9823 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9824 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9825 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9826 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9827 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9828 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9829
9830 @table @kbd
9831 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9832 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9833 @end table
9834
9835 @cindex #+TITLE
9836 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9837 @cindex #+DATE
9838 @cindex #+EMAIL
9839 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9840 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9841 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9842 @cindex #+TEXT
9843 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9844 @cindex #+BIND
9845 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9846 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9847 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9848 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9849 @cindex #+XSLT
9850 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9851 @vindex user-full-name
9852 @vindex user-mail-address
9853 @vindex org-export-default-language
9854 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9855 @example
9856 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9857 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9858 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9859 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9860 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9861 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9862 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9863 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9864 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9865 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9866 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9867 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9868 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9869 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9870 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9871 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9872 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9873 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9874 @end example
9875
9876 @noindent
9877 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9878 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9879 settings. Here you can:
9880 @cindex headline levels
9881 @cindex section-numbers
9882 @cindex table of contents
9883 @cindex line-break preservation
9884 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9885 @cindex fixed-width sections
9886 @cindex tables
9887 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9888 @cindex footnotes
9889 @cindex special strings
9890 @cindex emphasized text
9891 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9892 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9893 @cindex author info, in export
9894 @cindex time info, in export
9895 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9896 @vindex org-export-author-info
9897 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9898 @vindex org-export-email-info
9899 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9900 @example
9901 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9902 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9903 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9904 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9905 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9906 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9907 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9908 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9909 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9910 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9911 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9912 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9913 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9914 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9915 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9916 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9917 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9918 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9919 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9920 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9921 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9922 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9923 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9924 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9925 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9926 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9927 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9928 @end example
9929 @noindent
9930 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9931 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9932 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9933
9934 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9935 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9936 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9937 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9938
9939 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9940 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9941 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9942 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9943 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9944
9945 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9946 @section The export dispatcher
9947 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9948
9949 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9950 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9951 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9952 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9953 the subtrees are exported.
9954
9955 @table @kbd
9956 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9957 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9958 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9959 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9960 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9961 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9962 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9963 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9964 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9965 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9966 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
9967 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9968 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9969 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9970 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
9971 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9972 @end table
9973
9974 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9975 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9976 @cindex ASCII export
9977 @cindex Latin-1 export
9978 @cindex UTF-8 export
9979
9980 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9981 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9982 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9983
9984 @cindex region, active
9985 @cindex active region
9986 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9987 @table @kbd
9988 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9989 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9990 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9991 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9992 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9993 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9994 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9995 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9996 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9997 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9998 export.
9999 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10000 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10001 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10002 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10003 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10004 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10005 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10006 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10007 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10008 Export only the visible part of the document.
10009 @end table
10010
10011 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10012 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10013 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10014 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10015 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10016
10017 @example
10018 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10019 @end example
10020
10021 @noindent
10022 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10023 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10024 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10025 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10026 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10027 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10028 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10029
10030 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10031 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10032 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10033 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10034
10035 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10036 @section HTML export
10037 @cindex HTML export
10038
10039 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10040 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10041 language, but with additional support for tables.
10042
10043 @menu
10044 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10045 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10046 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10047 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10048 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10049 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10050 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10051 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10052 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10053 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10054 @end menu
10055
10056 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10057 @subsection HTML export commands
10058
10059 @cindex region, active
10060 @cindex active region
10061 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10062 @table @kbd
10063 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10064 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10065 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10066 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10067 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10068 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10069 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10070 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10071 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10072 property, that name will be used for the export.
10073 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10074 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10075 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10076 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10077 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10078 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10079 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10080 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10081 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10082 Export only the visible part of the document.
10083 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10084 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10085 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10086 buffer.
10087 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10088 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10089 code.
10090 @end table
10091
10092 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10093 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10094 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10095 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10096 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10097
10098 @example
10099 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10100 @end example
10101
10102 @noindent
10103 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10104
10105
10106 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10107 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10108 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10109 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10110 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10111 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10112 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10113 @vindex org-export-author-info
10114 @vindex org-export-email-info
10115 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10116 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10117
10118 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10119
10120 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10121 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10122 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10123
10124 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10125 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10126 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10127 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10128 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10129 insert any preamble.
10130
10131 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10132 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10133 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10134 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10135 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10136 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10137 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10138 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10139 insert any postamble.
10140
10141 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10142 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10143
10144 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
10145 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10146 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10147 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10148 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10149 the exported file use either
10150
10151 @cindex #+HTML
10152 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10153 @example
10154 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10155 @end example
10156
10157 @noindent or
10158 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10159
10160 @example
10161 #+BEGIN_HTML
10162 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10163 #+END_HTML
10164 @end example
10165
10166
10167 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10168 @subsection Links in HTML export
10169
10170 @cindex links, in HTML export
10171 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10172 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10173 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10174 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10175 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10176 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10177 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10178 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10179 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10180 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10181 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10182
10183 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10184 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10185 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10186 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10187
10188 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10189 @example
10190 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10191 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10192 @end example
10193
10194 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10195 @subsection Tables
10196 @cindex tables, in HTML
10197 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10198
10199 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10200 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10201 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10202 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10203
10204 @cindex #+CAPTION
10205 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10206 @example
10207 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10208 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10209 @end example
10210
10211 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10212 @subsection Images in HTML export
10213
10214 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10215 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10216 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10217 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10218 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10219 default@footnote{But see the variable
10220 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10221 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10222 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10223 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10224 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10225 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10226 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10227 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10228
10229 @example
10230 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10231 @end example
10232
10233 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10234 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10235 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10236
10237 @cindex #+CAPTION
10238 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10239 @example
10240 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10241 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10242 [[./img/a.jpg]]
10243 @end example
10244
10245 @noindent
10246 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10247
10248 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10249 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10250 @cindex MathJax
10251 @cindex dvipng
10252
10253 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10254 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10255 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10256 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10257 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10258 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10259 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10260 found on the MathJax website, see
10261 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10262 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10263 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10264 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10265
10266 @example
10267 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10268 @end example
10269
10270 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10271 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10272 this line.
10273
10274 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10275 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10276 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10277 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10278 You can still get this processing with
10279
10280 @example
10281 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10282 @end example
10283
10284 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10285 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10286
10287 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10288 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10289 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10290 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10291 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10292 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10293 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10294 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10295 respectively. For example
10296
10297 @example
10298 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10299 (defun org-xor (a b)
10300 "Exclusive or."
10301 (if a (not b) b))
10302 #+END_EXAMPLE
10303 @end example
10304
10305
10306 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10307 @subsection CSS support
10308 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10309 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10310
10311 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10312 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10313 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10314 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10315 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10316 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10317 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10318 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10319 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10320 @example
10321 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10322 p.date @r{publishing date}
10323 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10324 .title @r{document title}
10325 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10326 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10327 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10328 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10329 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10330 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10331 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10332 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10333 .target @r{target for links}
10334 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10335 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10336 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10337 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10338 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10339 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10340 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10341 pre.example @r{normal example}
10342 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10343 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10344 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10345 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10346 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10347 @end example
10348
10349 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10350 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10351 @vindex org-export-html-style
10352 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10353 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10354 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10355 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10356 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10357 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10358 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10359 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10360 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10361 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10362 individually for each file, you can use
10363
10364 @cindex #+STYLE
10365 @example
10366 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10367 @end example
10368
10369 @noindent
10370 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10371 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10372 referring to an external file.
10373
10374 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10375 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10376 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10377 property.
10378
10379 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10380 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10381
10382 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10383 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10384
10385 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10386 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10387 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10388 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10389 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10390 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10391 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10392 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10393 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10394 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10395 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10396 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10397 copy on your own web server.
10398
10399 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10400 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10401 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10402 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10403 adding a single line to the Org file:
10404
10405 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10406 @example
10407 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10408 @end example
10409
10410 @noindent
10411 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10412 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10413 viewing options:
10414
10415 @example
10416 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10417 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10418 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10419 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10420 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10421 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10422 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10423 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10424 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10425 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10426 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10427 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10428 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10429 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10430 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10431 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10432 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10433 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10434 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10435 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10436 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10437 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10438 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10439 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10440 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10441 @end example
10442 @noindent
10443 @vindex org-infojs-options
10444 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10445 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10446 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10447 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10448
10449 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10450 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10451 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10452 @cindex PDF export
10453 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10454
10455 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10456 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10457 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10458 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10459 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10460 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10461 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10462 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10463 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10464 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10465 sections.
10466
10467 @menu
10468 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10469 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10470 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10471 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10472 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10473 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10474 @end menu
10475
10476 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10477 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10478
10479 @cindex region, active
10480 @cindex active region
10481 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10482 @table @kbd
10483 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10484 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10485 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10486 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10487 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10488 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10489 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10490 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10491 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10492 property, that name will be used for the export.
10493 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10494 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10495 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10496 Export only the visible part of the document.
10497 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10498 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10499 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10500 buffer.
10501 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10502 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10503 code.
10504 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10505 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10506 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10507 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10508 @end table
10509
10510 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10511 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10512 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10513 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10514 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10515 convert them to a custom string depending on
10516 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10517
10518 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10519 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10520
10521 @example
10522 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10523 @end example
10524
10525 @noindent
10526 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10527
10528 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10529 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10530 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10531 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10532 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10533 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10534 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10535
10536 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10537
10538 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10539 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10540 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10541 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10542 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10543 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10544 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10545 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10546 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10547 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10548 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10549 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10550 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10551 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10552 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10553 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10554 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10555 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10556 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10557 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10558 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10559 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10560 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10561 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10562 below.
10563
10564 @example
10565 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10566 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10567 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10568
10569 * Headline 1
10570 some text
10571 @end example
10572
10573 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10574 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10575
10576 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10577 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10578 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10579 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10580 the following constructs:
10581
10582 @cindex #+LaTeX
10583 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10584 @example
10585 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10586 @end example
10587
10588 @noindent or
10589 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10590
10591 @example
10592 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10593 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10594 #+END_LaTeX
10595 @end example
10596
10597
10598 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10599 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10600 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10601
10602 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10603 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10604 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10605 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10606 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10607 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10608 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10609 width:
10610
10611 @cindex #+CAPTION
10612 @cindex #+LABEL
10613 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10614 @example
10615 #+CAPTION: A long table
10616 #+LABEL: tbl:long
10617 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10618 | ..... | ..... |
10619 | ..... | ..... |
10620 @end example
10621
10622 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10623
10624 @cindex #+CAPTION
10625 @cindex #+LABEL
10626 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10627 @example
10628 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10629 #+LABEL: tbl:wide
10630 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10631 | ..... | ..... |
10632 | ..... | ..... |
10633 @end example
10634
10635 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10636 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10637 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10638 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10639
10640 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10641 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10642 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10643 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10644 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10645 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10646 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10647 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10648 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10649 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10650 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10651 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10652 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10653 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10654 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10655 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10656
10657 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10658 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10659 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10660 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10661 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10662 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10663
10664 @cindex #+CAPTION
10665 @cindex #+LABEL
10666 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10667 @example
10668 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10669 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10670 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10671 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10672
10673 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10674 [[./img/hst.png]]
10675 @end example
10676
10677 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10678 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10679 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10680
10681 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10682 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10683
10684 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10685 @subsection Beamer class export
10686
10687 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10688 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10689 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10690
10691 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10692 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10693 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10694 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10695 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10696 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10697 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10698 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10699 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10700 structure of the presentation.
10701
10702 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10703 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10704 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10705 editing special properties used by beamer.
10706
10707 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10708 properties:
10709
10710 @table @code
10711 @item BEAMER_env
10712 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10713 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10714 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10715 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10716 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10717 @item BEAMER_envargs
10718 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10719 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10720 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10721 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10722 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10723 environment.
10724 @item BEAMER_col
10725 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10726 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10727 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10728 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10729 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10730 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10731 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10732 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10733 @item BEAMER_extra
10734 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10735 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10736 transitions.
10737 @end table
10738
10739 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10740 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10741 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10742 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10743 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10744 in the presentation as well.
10745
10746 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10747 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10748 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10749 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10750 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10751 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10752 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10753
10754 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10755 support with
10756
10757 @example
10758 #+STARTUP: beamer
10759 @end example
10760
10761 @table @kbd
10762 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10763 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10764 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10765 @end table
10766
10767 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10768 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10769 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10770 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10771
10772 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10773
10774 @smallexample
10775 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10776 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10777 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10778 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10779 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10780 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10781 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10782
10783 * This is the first structural section
10784
10785 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10786 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10787 :PROPERTIES:
10788 :BEAMER_env: block
10789 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10790 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10791 :END:
10792 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10793 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10794 :PROPERTIES:
10795 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10796 :BEAMER_env: block
10797 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10798 :END:
10799 for contributing to the discussion
10800 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10801 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10802 *** Request :B_block:
10803 Please test this stuff!
10804 :PROPERTIES:
10805 :BEAMER_env: block
10806 :END:
10807 @end smallexample
10808
10809 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10810
10811 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10812 @section DocBook export
10813 @cindex DocBook export
10814 @cindex PDF export
10815 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10816
10817 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10818 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10819 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10820 tools and stylesheets.
10821
10822 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10823
10824 @menu
10825 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10826 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10827 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10828 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10829 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10830 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10831 @end menu
10832
10833 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10834 @subsection DocBook export commands
10835
10836 @cindex region, active
10837 @cindex active region
10838 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10839 @table @kbd
10840 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10841 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10842 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10843 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10844 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10845 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10846 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10847 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10848 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10849 property, that name will be used for the export.
10850 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10851 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10852
10853 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10854 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10855 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10856 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10857 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10858 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10859
10860 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10861 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10862 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10863 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10864 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10865 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10866
10867 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10868 Export only the visible part of the document.
10869 @end table
10870
10871 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10872 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10873
10874 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10875 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10876
10877 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10878 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10879 @example
10880 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10881 @end example
10882
10883 @noindent or
10884 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10885
10886 @example
10887 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10888 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10889 literally.
10890 #+END_DOCBOOK
10891 @end example
10892
10893 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10894 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10895 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10896 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10897
10898 @example
10899 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10900 <warning>
10901 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10902 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10903 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10904 </warning>
10905 #+END_DOCBOOK
10906 @end example
10907
10908 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10909 @subsection Recursive sections
10910 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10911
10912 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10913 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
10914 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10915 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10916 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10917 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10918
10919 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10920 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10921
10922 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10923 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10924 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10925
10926 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10927 DocBook V4.3.
10928
10929 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10930 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10931 using the @code{table} element.
10932
10933 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10934 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10935 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10936 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10937
10938 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10939 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10940 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10941 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10942 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10943 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10944 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10945 @code{mediaobject} element.
10946
10947 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10948 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10949 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10950 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10951 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10952 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10953 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10954 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10955
10956 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10957 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10958 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10959 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10960 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10961 set:
10962
10963 @cindex #+CAPTION
10964 @cindex #+LABEL
10965 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10966 @example
10967 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10968 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10969 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10970 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10971 @end example
10972
10973 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10974 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10975 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10976 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10977 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10978
10979 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10980 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10981 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10982
10983 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10984 @vindex org-entities
10985 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10986 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10987 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10988 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10989 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10990 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10991
10992 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10993 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10994 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10995 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10996
10997 @example
10998 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10999 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11000 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11001 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11002 >
11003 %xhtml1-symbol;
11004 ]>
11005 "
11006 @end example
11007
11008 @c begin opendocument
11009
11010 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11011 @section OpenDocument Text export
11012 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11013 @cindex ODT
11014 @cindex OpenDocument
11015 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11016 @cindex LibreOffice
11017 @cindex org-odt.el
11018 @cindex org-modules
11019
11020 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11021 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11022 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11023 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11024 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11025 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11026
11027 @menu
11028 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11029 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11030 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11031 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11032 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11033 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11034 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11035 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11036 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11037 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11038 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11039 @end menu
11040
11041 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11042 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11043 @cindex zip
11044 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11045 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11046
11047 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11048 @subsection ODT export commands
11049
11050 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11051 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11052
11053 @cindex region, active
11054 @cindex active region
11055 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11056 @table @kbd
11057 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11058 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11059
11060 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11061
11062 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11063 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11064 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11065 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11066
11067 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11068 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11069 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11070 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11071 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11072 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11073 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11074 export.
11075
11076 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11077 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11078
11079 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11080 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11081 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11082 exporting to other formats}.
11083 @end table
11084
11085 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11086 @subsection Extending ODT export
11087
11088 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11089 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11090 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11091 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11092
11093 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11094 @cindex LibreOffice
11095 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11096 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11097 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11098 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11099 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11100 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11101 document converter}.
11102
11103 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11104 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11105
11106 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11107 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11108 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11109 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11110 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11111 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11112 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11113 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11114
11115 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11116 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11117
11118 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11119 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11120 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11121 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11122 the following command.
11123
11124 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11125 @table @kbd
11126
11127 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11128 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11129 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11130 @end table
11131
11132 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11133 @subsection Applying custom styles
11134 @cindex styles, custom
11135 @cindex template, custom
11136
11137 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11138 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11139 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11140 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11141 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11142 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11143 users alike, and is described here.
11144
11145 @subsubsection Applying custom styles: the easy way
11146
11147 @enumerate
11148 @item
11149 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11150 to ODT format.
11151
11152 @example
11153 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11154 @end example
11155
11156 @item
11157 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11158 to locate the target styles---these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix---and
11159 modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11160 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11161
11162 @item
11163 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11164 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11165 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11166 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11167 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11168
11169 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11170 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11171
11172 @example
11173 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11174 @end example
11175
11176 or
11177
11178 @example
11179 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11180 @end example
11181
11182 @end enumerate
11183
11184 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11185
11186 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11187 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11188 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11189 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11190 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11191 the factory settings.
11192
11193 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11194 @subsection Links in ODT export
11195 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11196
11197 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11198 Internet-style links for all other links.
11199
11200 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11201 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11202
11203 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11204 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11205 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11206
11207 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11208 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11209 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11210
11211 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11212 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables---tables
11213 that have column or row spans---is not supported. Such tables are
11214 stripped from the exported document.
11215
11216 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11217 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11218 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11219 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11220 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11221 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11222
11223 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11224 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11225 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11226
11227 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11228 mentioned above.
11229
11230 @example
11231 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11232 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11233 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11234 | / | < | | | < |
11235 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11236 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11237 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11238 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11239 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11240 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11241 @end example
11242
11243 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11244 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11245 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11246 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11247 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11248
11249 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11250 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11251 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11252
11253 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11254 @subsection Images in ODT export
11255 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11256 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11257
11258 @subsubheading Embedding images
11259 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11260 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11261 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11262
11263 @example
11264 [[file:img.png]]
11265 @end example
11266
11267 @example
11268 [[./img.png]]
11269 @end example
11270
11271 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11272 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11273 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11274 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11275 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11276
11277 @example
11278 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11279 @end example
11280
11281 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11282
11283 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11284 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11285 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11286
11287 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11288 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11289 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11290 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11291 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11292 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11293 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11294 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11295 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11296 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11297 converted in to units of centimeters using
11298 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11299 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11300 achieve the best results.
11301
11302 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11303
11304 @table @asis
11305 @item Explicitly size the image
11306 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11307
11308 @example
11309 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11310 [[./img.png]]
11311 @end example
11312
11313 @item Scale the image
11314 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11315
11316 @example
11317 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11318 [[./img.png]]
11319 @end example
11320
11321 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11322 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11323 height:width ratio, do the following:
11324
11325 @example
11326 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11327 [[./img.png]]
11328 @end example
11329
11330 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11331 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11332 height:width ratio, do the following
11333
11334 @example
11335 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11336 [[./img.png]]
11337 @end example
11338 @end table
11339
11340 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11341
11342 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11343 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11344 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11345 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property:
11346 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11347
11348 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11349 @example
11350 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11351 [[./img.png]]
11352 @end example
11353
11354 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11355 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11356
11357 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11358
11359 @menu
11360 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11361 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11362 @end menu
11363
11364 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11365 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11366
11367 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11368 document in one of the following ways:
11369
11370 @cindex MathML
11371 @enumerate
11372 @item MathML
11373
11374 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11375
11376 @example
11377 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t
11378 @end example
11379
11380 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11381 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11382 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11383 the exported document.
11384
11385 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11386 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11387
11388 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11389 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11390 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11391
11392 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11393 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11394 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11395
11396 @lisp
11397 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11398 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11399 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11400 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11401 @end lisp
11402
11403 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11404 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11405
11406 @table @kbd
11407
11408 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11409 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11410
11411 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11412 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11413 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11414 @end table
11415
11416 @cindex dvipng
11417 @item PNG images
11418
11419 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11420
11421 @example
11422 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11423 @end example
11424
11425 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11426 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11427 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11428 @end enumerate
11429
11430 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11431 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11432
11433 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11434 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11435 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11436 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11437
11438 @example
11439 [[./equation.mml]]
11440 @end example
11441
11442 or
11443
11444 @example
11445 [[./equation.odf]]
11446 @end example
11447
11448 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11449 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11450
11451 You can label and caption various category of objects---an inline image, a
11452 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula---using @code{#+LABEL} and
11453 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11454 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11455 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11456 appearance in the Org file.
11457
11458 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11459 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11460 file.
11461
11462 @example
11463 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11464 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11465 [[./img/a.png]]
11466 @end example
11467
11468 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11469
11470 @example
11471 Figure 2: Bell curve
11472 @end example
11473
11474 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11475 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11476 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11477 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11478 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11479
11480 @lisp
11481 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11482 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11483 @end lisp
11484
11485 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11486 document.
11487
11488 @example
11489 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11490 @end example
11491
11492 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11493 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11494
11495 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11496 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11497 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11498 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11499 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11500 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11501 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11502
11503 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11504 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11505 by customizing the variable
11506 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11507
11508 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11509 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11510 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11511
11512 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11513 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11514
11515 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11516 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11517 that would be of interest to power users.
11518
11519 @menu
11520 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11521 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11522 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11523 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11524 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11525 @end menu
11526
11527 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11528 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11529 @cindex convert
11530 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11531 @cindex converter
11532
11533 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11534 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11535 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11536 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11537
11538 @enumerate
11539 @item Register the converter
11540
11541 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11542 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11543 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11544 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11545
11546 @item Configure its capabilities
11547
11548 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11549 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11550 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11551 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11552 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11553 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11554 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11555 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11556
11557 @item Choose the converter
11558
11559 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11560 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11561 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11562 @end enumerate
11563
11564 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11565 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11566 @cindex styles, custom
11567 @cindex template, custom
11568
11569 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11570 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11571 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11572 the exporter.
11573
11574 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11575 @subsubheading Factory styles
11576
11577 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11578 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11579 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11580
11581 @itemize
11582 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11583 @item
11584 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11585
11586 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11587 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11588 @enumerate
11589
11590 @item
11591 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11592
11593 @item
11594 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11595 blocks.
11596 @end enumerate
11597
11598 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11599 @item
11600 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11601
11602 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11603 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11604 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11605
11606 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11607 file serves the following purposes:
11608 @enumerate
11609
11610 @item
11611 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11612 the exporter.
11613
11614 @item
11615 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11616 elements that control how various entities---tables, images, equations,
11617 etc.---are numbered.
11618 @end enumerate
11619 @end itemize
11620
11621 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11622 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11623 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11624 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11625 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11626 exporter.
11627
11628 @itemize
11629 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11630 @item
11631 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11632
11633 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11634 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11635
11636 @enumerate
11637 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11638
11639 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11640
11641 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11642
11643 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11644 Template file
11645
11646 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11647
11648 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11649 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11650 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11651
11652 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11653 like header and footer images.
11654
11655 @item @code{nil}
11656
11657 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11658 @end enumerate
11659
11660 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11661 @item
11662 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11663
11664 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11665 in the final output.
11666 @end itemize
11667
11668 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11669 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11670
11671 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11672 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11673 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11674
11675 @enumerate
11676 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11677
11678 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11679 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11680
11681 @example
11682 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11683 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11684 regular text.
11685 @end example
11686
11687 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11688 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11689 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11690
11691 @example
11692 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11693 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11694 </style:style>
11695 @end example
11696
11697 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11698
11699 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11700 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11701
11702 @example
11703 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11704 @end example
11705
11706 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11707 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11708 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11709
11710 @example
11711 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11712 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11713 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11714 </style:style>
11715 @end example
11716
11717 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11718
11719 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11720 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11721
11722 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11723 following:
11724
11725 @example
11726 #+BEGIN_ODT
11727 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11728 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11729 </text:p>
11730 #+END_ODT
11731 @end example
11732
11733 @end enumerate
11734
11735 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11736 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11737 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11738
11739 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11740 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11741 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11742 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11743
11744 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11745 OpenDocument-v1.2
11746 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11747 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11748
11749
11750
11751 @subsubheading Custom table styles: an illustration
11752
11753 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11754 the table that follows.
11755
11756 @lisp
11757 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11758 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11759 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11760 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11761 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11762 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11763 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11764 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11765 @end lisp
11766
11767 @example
11768 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11769 | Name | Phone | Age |
11770 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11771 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11772 @end example
11773
11774 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11775 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11776 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11777 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11778 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11779 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11780 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11781 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11782
11783 @subsubheading Custom table styles: the nitty-gritty
11784 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11785
11786 @enumerate
11787 @item
11788 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11789 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11790
11791 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11792 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11793
11794 @itemize @minus
11795 @item Body
11796 @item First column
11797 @item Last column
11798 @item First row
11799 @item Last row
11800 @item Even row
11801 @item Odd row
11802 @item Even column
11803 @item Odd Column
11804 @end itemize
11805
11806 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11807 template using a well-defined convention.
11808
11809 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11810 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11811 the following table.
11812
11813 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11814 @headitem Table cell type
11815 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11816 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11817 @item
11818 @tab
11819 @tab
11820 @item Body
11821 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11822 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11823 @item First column
11824 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11825 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11826 @item Last column
11827 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11828 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11829 @item First row
11830 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11831 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11832 @item Last row
11833 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11834 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11835 @item Even row
11836 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11837 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11838 @item Odd row
11839 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11840 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11841 @item Even column
11842 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11843 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11844 @item Odd column
11845 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11846 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11847 @end multitable
11848
11849 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11850 styles in the
11851 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11852 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11853 styles}).
11854
11855 @item
11856 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11857 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11858 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11859 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11860 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11861 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11862
11863 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11864 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11865 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11866
11867 @itemize @minus
11868 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11869 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11870 @end itemize
11871
11872 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11873 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11874 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11875 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11876
11877 @lisp
11878 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11879 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11880 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11881 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11882 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11883 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11884 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11885 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11886 @end lisp
11887
11888 @item
11889 Associate a table with the table style
11890
11891 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11892 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11893
11894 @example
11895 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11896 | Name | Phone | Age |
11897 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11898 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11899 @end example
11900 @end enumerate
11901
11902 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11903 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11904
11905 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11906 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11907 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11908 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11909 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11910
11911 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11912 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11913 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11914 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11915
11916 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11917 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11918 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11919 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11920 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11921 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11922
11923 @c end opendocument
11924
11925 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11926 @section TaskJuggler export
11927 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11928 @cindex Project management
11929
11930 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11931 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11932 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11933 you have provided.
11934
11935 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11936 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11937 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11938 document.
11939
11940 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11941 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11942 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11943 all the nodes.
11944
11945 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11946
11947 @table @kbd
11948 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11949 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11950
11951 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11952 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11953 @end table
11954
11955 @subsection Tasks
11956
11957 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11958 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11959 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11960 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11961 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11962 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11963 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11964 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11965 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11966 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11967
11968 @subsection Resources
11969
11970 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11971 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11972 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11973 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11974 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11975 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11976 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11977 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11978 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11979 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11980 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11981 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11982 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11983
11984 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11985 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11986 time.
11987
11988 @subsection Export of properties
11989
11990 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if a
11991 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11992 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11993 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
11994 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
11995 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
11996 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
11997 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
11998 @samp{scheduling}, etc.@: for tasks.
11999
12000 @subsection Dependencies
12001
12002 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12003 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12004 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12005 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12006 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12007 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12008 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12009 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12010 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12011 examples should illustrate this:
12012
12013 @example
12014 * Preparation
12015 :PROPERTIES:
12016 :task_id: preparation
12017 :ORDERED: t
12018 :END:
12019 * Training material
12020 :PROPERTIES:
12021 :task_id: training_material
12022 :ORDERED: t
12023 :END:
12024 ** Markup Guidelines
12025 :PROPERTIES:
12026 :Effort: 2d
12027 :END:
12028 ** Workflow Guidelines
12029 :PROPERTIES:
12030 :Effort: 2d
12031 :END:
12032 * Presentation
12033 :PROPERTIES:
12034 :Effort: 2d
12035 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12036 :END:
12037 @end example
12038
12039 @subsection Reports
12040
12041 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12042 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12043 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12044 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12045 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12046 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12047 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12048 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12049
12050 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12051 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12052
12053 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12054 @section Freemind export
12055 @cindex Freemind export
12056 @cindex mind map
12057
12058 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12059
12060 @table @kbd
12061 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12062 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12063 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12064 @end table
12065
12066 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12067 @section XOXO export
12068 @cindex XOXO export
12069
12070 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12071 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12072 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12073
12074 @table @kbd
12075 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12076 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12077 @file{myfile.html}.
12078 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12079 Export only the visible part of the document.
12080 @end table
12081
12082 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12083 @section iCalendar export
12084 @cindex iCalendar export
12085
12086 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12087 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12088 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12089 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12090 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12091 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12092 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12093 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12094 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12095 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12096 included in the export, configure the variable
12097 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12098 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12099 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12100 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12101 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12102 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12103 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12104 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12105 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12106 time.
12107
12108 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12109 @cindex property, ID
12110 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12111 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12112 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12113 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12114 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12115 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12116 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12117 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12118 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12119
12120 @table @kbd
12121 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12122 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12123 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12124 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12125 @vindex org-agenda-files
12126 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12127 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12128 file will be written.
12129 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12130 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12131 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12132 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12133 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12134 @end table
12135
12136 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12137 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12138 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12139 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12140 @cindex property, LOCATION
12141 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12142 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12143 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12144 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12145 and the description from the body (limited to
12146 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12147
12148 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12149 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12150
12151 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12152 @chapter Publishing
12153 @cindex publishing
12154
12155 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12156 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12157 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12158 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12159 server.
12160
12161 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12162 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12163
12164 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12165
12166 @menu
12167 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12168 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12169 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12170 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12171 @end menu
12172
12173 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12174 @section Configuration
12175
12176 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12177 and many other properties of a project.
12178
12179 @menu
12180 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12181 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12182 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12183 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12184 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12185 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12186 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12187 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12188 @end menu
12189
12190 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12191 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12192 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12193 @cindex projects, for publishing
12194
12195 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12196 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12197 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12198 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12199
12200 @lisp
12201 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12202 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12203 @r{or}
12204 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12205
12206 @end lisp
12207
12208 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12209 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12210 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12211 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12212 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12213 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12214 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12215 sequence given.
12216
12217 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12218 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12219 @cindex directories, for publishing
12220
12221 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12222 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12223 and where to put published files.
12224
12225 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12226 @item @code{:base-directory}
12227 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12228 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12229 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12230 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12231 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12232 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12233 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12234 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12235 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12236 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12237 variable @code{project-plist}.
12238 @item @code{:completion-function}
12239 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12240 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12241 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12242 @code{project-plist}.
12243 @end multitable
12244 @noindent
12245
12246 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12247 @subsection Selecting files
12248 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12249
12250 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12251 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12252 properties
12253 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12254 @item @code{:base-extension}
12255 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12256 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12257 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12258
12259 @item @code{:exclude}
12260 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12261 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12262 extension.
12263
12264 @item @code{:include}
12265 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12266 and @code{:exclude}.
12267
12268 @item @code{:recursive}
12269 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12270 @end multitable
12271
12272 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12273 @subsection Publishing action
12274 @cindex action, for publishing
12275
12276 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12277 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12278 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12279 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12280 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12281 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12282 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12283 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12284 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12285 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12286 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12287 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12288 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12289 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12290 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12291 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12292 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12293 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12294 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12295
12296 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12297 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12298 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12299 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12300 @item @code{:plain-source}
12301 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12302 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12303 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12304 @end multitable
12305
12306 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12307 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12308 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12309 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12310 and place the result into the destination folder.
12311
12312 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12313 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12314 @cindex options, for publishing
12315
12316 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12317 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12318 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12319 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12320 respective variable for details.
12321
12322 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12323 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12324 @vindex org-export-default-language
12325 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12326 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12327 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12328 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12329 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12330 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12331 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12332 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12333 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12334 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12335 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12336 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12337 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12338 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12339 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12340 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12341 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12342 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12343 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12344 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12345 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12346 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12347 @vindex org-export-author-info
12348 @vindex org-export-email-info
12349 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12350 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12351 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12352 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12353 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12354 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12355 @vindex org-export-html-style
12356 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12357 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12358 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12359 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12360 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12361 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12362 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12363 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12364 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12365 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12366 @vindex user-full-name
12367 @vindex user-mail-address
12368 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12369 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12370
12371 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12372 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12373 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12374 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12375 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12376 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12377 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12378 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12379 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12380 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12381 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12382 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12383 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12384 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12385 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12386 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12387 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12388 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12389 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12390 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12391 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12392 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12393 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12394 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12395 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12396 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12397 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12398 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12399 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12400 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12401 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12402 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12403 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12404 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12405 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12406 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12407 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12408 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12409 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12410 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12411 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12412 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12413 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12414 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12415 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12416 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12417 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12418 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12419 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12420 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12421 @end multitable
12422
12423 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12424 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12425 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12426 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12427 options.
12428
12429
12430
12431 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12432 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12433 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12434 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12435 options}), however, override everything.
12436
12437 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12438 @subsection Links between published files
12439 @cindex links, publishing
12440
12441 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12442 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12443 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12444 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12445 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12446 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12447 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12448 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12449 @file{html} file.
12450
12451 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12452 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12453 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12454 an example of this usage.
12455
12456 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12457 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12458 location. In this case, use the property
12459
12460 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12461 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12462 @tab Function to validate links
12463 @end multitable
12464
12465 @noindent
12466 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12467 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12468 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12469 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12470 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12471 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12472 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12473
12474 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12475 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12476 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12477
12478 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12479 a map of files for a given project.
12480
12481 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12482 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12483 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12484 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12485
12486 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12487 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12488 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12489
12490 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12491 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12492
12493 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12494 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12495 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12496 of links to all files in the project.
12497
12498 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12499 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12500 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12501 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12502
12503 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12504 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12505 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12506 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12507 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12508 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12509 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12510
12511 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12512 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12513
12514 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12515 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12516 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12517 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12518 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12519 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12520 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12521
12522 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12523 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12524 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12525 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12526
12527 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12528 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12529 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12530 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12531
12532 @end multitable
12533
12534 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12535 @subsection Generating an index
12536 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12537
12538 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12539
12540 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12541 @item @code{:makeindex}
12542 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12543 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12544 @end multitable
12545
12546 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12547 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12548 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12549 a title, style information, etc.
12550
12551 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12552 @section Uploading files
12553 @cindex rsync
12554 @cindex unison
12555
12556 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12557 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12558 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12559 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12560 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12561 under heavy usage.
12562
12563 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12564 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12565 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12566 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12567 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12568
12569 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12570 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12571 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12572 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12573 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12574 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12575 tool syncs them.
12576
12577 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12578 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12579 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12580 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12581 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12582 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12583
12584 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12585 @section Sample configuration
12586
12587 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12588 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12589 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12590
12591 @menu
12592 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12593 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12594 @end menu
12595
12596 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12597 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12598
12599 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12600 directory on the local machine.
12601
12602 @lisp
12603 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12604 '(("org"
12605 :base-directory "~/org/"
12606 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12607 :section-numbers nil
12608 :table-of-contents nil
12609 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12610 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12611 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12612 @end lisp
12613
12614 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12615 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12616
12617 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12618 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12619 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12620 excluded.
12621
12622 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12623 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12624 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12625 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12626 @c
12627 @example
12628 file:../images/myimage.png
12629 @end example
12630 @c
12631 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12632 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12633 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12634
12635 @lisp
12636 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12637 '(("orgfiles"
12638 :base-directory "~/org/"
12639 :base-extension "org"
12640 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12641 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12642 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12643 :headline-levels 3
12644 :section-numbers nil
12645 :table-of-contents nil
12646 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12647 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12648 :html-preamble t)
12649
12650 ("images"
12651 :base-directory "~/images/"
12652 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12653 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12654 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12655
12656 ("other"
12657 :base-directory "~/other/"
12658 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12659 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12660 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12661 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12662 @end lisp
12663
12664 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12665 @section Triggering publication
12666
12667 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12668
12669 @table @kbd
12670 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12671 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12672 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12673 Publish the project containing the current file.
12674 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12675 Publish only the current file.
12676 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12677 Publish every project.
12678 @end table
12679
12680 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12681 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12682 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12683 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12684 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12685 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12686 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12687
12688 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12689 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12690
12691 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12692 @chapter Working with source code
12693 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12694 @cindex Davison, Dan
12695 @cindex source code, working with
12696
12697 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12698 e.g.:
12699
12700 @example
12701 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12702 (defun org-xor (a b)
12703 "Exclusive or."
12704 (if a (not b) b))
12705 #+END_SRC
12706 @end example
12707
12708 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12709 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12710 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12711 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12712 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12713 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12714
12715 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12716
12717 @menu
12718 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12719 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12720 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12721 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12722 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12723 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12724 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12725 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12726 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12727 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12728 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12729 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12730 @end menu
12731
12732 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12733 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12734
12735 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12736 @section Structure of code blocks
12737 @cindex code block, structure
12738 @cindex source code, block structure
12739 @cindex #+NAME
12740 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12741
12742 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12743 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12744 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12745
12746 @example
12747 #+NAME: <name>
12748 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12749 <body>
12750 #+END_SRC
12751 @end example
12752
12753 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12754 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12755 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12756 @cindex source code, inline
12757
12758 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12759
12760 @example
12761 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12762 @end example
12763
12764 or
12765
12766 @example
12767 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12768 @end example
12769
12770 @table @code
12771 @item <#+NAME: name>
12772 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12773 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12774 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12775 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12776 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12777 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12778 undefined.
12779 @cindex #+NAME
12780 @item <language>
12781 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12782 @cindex source code, language
12783 @item <switches>
12784 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12785 @ref{Literal examples})
12786 @cindex source code, switches
12787 @item <header arguments>
12788 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12789 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12790 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12791 basis using properties.
12792 @item source code, header arguments
12793 @item <body>
12794 Source code in the specified language.
12795 @end table
12796
12797 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12798 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12799
12800 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12801 @section Editing source code
12802 @cindex code block, editing
12803 @cindex source code, editing
12804
12805 @kindex C-c '
12806 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12807 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12808 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12809 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12810
12811 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12812 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12813 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12814 further configuration options.
12815
12816 @table @code
12817 @item org-src-lang-modes
12818 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12819 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12820 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12821 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12822 @item org-src-window-setup
12823 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12824 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12825 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12826 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12827 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12828 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12829 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12830 @end table
12831
12832 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12833 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12834
12835 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12836 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12837
12838 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12839 @section Exporting code blocks
12840 @cindex code block, exporting
12841 @cindex source code, exporting
12842
12843 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12844 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12845 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12846 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12847 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12848 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12849
12850 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12851 behavior:
12852
12853 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12854 @table @code
12855 @item :exports code
12856 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12857 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12858 @item :exports results
12859 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12860 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12861 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12862 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12863 block will not be exported.
12864 @item :exports both
12865 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12866 @item :exports none
12867 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12868 @end table
12869
12870 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12871 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12872 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12873 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12874 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12875 markup language for a wiki.
12876
12877 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12878 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12879 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12880 @section Extracting source code
12881 @cindex tangling
12882 @cindex source code, extracting
12883 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12884
12885 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12886 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12887 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12888 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12889 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12890
12891 @subsubheading Header arguments
12892 @table @code
12893 @item :tangle no
12894 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12895 @item :tangle yes
12896 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12897 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12898 for the block language.
12899 @item :tangle filename
12900 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12901 @end table
12902
12903 @kindex C-c C-v t
12904 @subsubheading Functions
12905 @table @code
12906 @item org-babel-tangle
12907 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12908 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12909 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12910 @end table
12911
12912 @subsubheading Hooks
12913 @table @code
12914 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12915 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12916 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12917 of tangled code files.
12918 @end table
12919
12920 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12921 @section Evaluating code blocks
12922 @cindex code block, evaluating
12923 @cindex source code, evaluating
12924 @cindex #+RESULTS
12925
12926 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12927 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12928 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12929 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12930 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12931 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12932 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12933 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12934 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12935 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12936
12937 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12938 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12939 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12940 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12941 used to define a code block).
12942
12943 @kindex C-c C-c
12944 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12945 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12946 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12947 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12948 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12949 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12950 @cindex #+CALL
12951
12952 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12953 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12954 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12955 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12956 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12957
12958 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12959
12960 @example
12961 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12962 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12963 @end example
12964
12965 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12966
12967 @example
12968 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12969 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12970 @end example
12971
12972 @table @code
12973 @item <name>
12974 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12975 @item <arguments>
12976 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12977 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12978 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12979 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12980 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12981 @item <inside header arguments>
12982 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12983 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12984 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12985 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12986 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12987 @item <end header arguments>
12988 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12989 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12990 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12991 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12992 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12993
12994 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
12995 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
12996 @end table
12997
12998 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
12999 @section Library of Babel
13000 @cindex babel, library of
13001 @cindex source code, library
13002 @cindex code block, library
13003
13004 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13005 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13006 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13007 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13008
13009
13010 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13011 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13012
13013 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13014 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13015 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13016
13017
13018 @kindex C-c C-v i
13019 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13020 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13021 i}.
13022
13023 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13024 @section Languages
13025 @cindex babel, languages
13026 @cindex source code, languages
13027 @cindex code block, languages
13028
13029 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13030
13031 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13032 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13033 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13034 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13035 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13036 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13037 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13038 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13039 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13040 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13041 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13042 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13043 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13044 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13045 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13046 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13047 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13048 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13049 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13050 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13051 @end multitable
13052
13053 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13054 available, it can be found at
13055 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13056
13057 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13058 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13059 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13060 to your emacs configuration.
13061
13062 @quotation
13063 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13064 @code{R} code blocks.
13065 @end quotation
13066
13067 @lisp
13068 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13069 'org-babel-load-languages
13070 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13071 (R . t)))
13072 @end lisp
13073
13074 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13075 elisp file with @code{require}.
13076
13077 @quotation
13078 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13079 @end quotation
13080
13081 @lisp
13082 (require 'ob-clojure)
13083 @end lisp
13084
13085 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13086 @section Header arguments
13087 @cindex code block, header arguments
13088 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13089
13090 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13091 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13092 describes each header argument in detail.
13093
13094 @menu
13095 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13096 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13097 @end menu
13098
13099 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13100 @subsection Using header arguments
13101
13102 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13103 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13104 @menu
13105 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13106 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13107 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13108 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13109 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13110 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13111 @end menu
13112
13113
13114 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13115 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13116 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13117 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13118 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13119
13120 @example
13121 :session => "none"
13122 :results => "replace"
13123 :exports => "code"
13124 :cache => "no"
13125 :noweb => "no"
13126 @end example
13127
13128 @c @example
13129 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13130 @c Its value is
13131 @c ((:session . "none")
13132 @c (:results . "replace")
13133 @c (:exports . "code")
13134 @c (:cache . "no")
13135 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13136
13137
13138 @c Documentation:
13139 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13140 @c @end example
13141
13142 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13143 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13144 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13145 blocks.
13146
13147 @lisp
13148 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13149 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13150 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13151 @end lisp
13152
13153 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13154 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13155 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13156 language-specific documentation available online at
13157 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13158
13159 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13160 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13161 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13162 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13163 @ref{Property syntax}).
13164
13165 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13166 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13167 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13168 inserted into the buffer.
13169
13170 @example
13171 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13172 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13173 @end example
13174
13175 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13176 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13177
13178 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13179 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13180 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13181
13182 @example
13183 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13184 @end example
13185
13186 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13187 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13188 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13189 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13190 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13191 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13192
13193 @example
13194 * outline header
13195 :PROPERTIES:
13196 :cache: yes
13197 :END:
13198 @end example
13199
13200 @kindex C-c C-x p
13201 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13202 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13203 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13204 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13205 in Org mode documents.
13206
13207 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13208 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13209
13210 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13211 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13212 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13213 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13214 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13215 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13216 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13217 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13218 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13219 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13220
13221 @example
13222 #+NAME: factorial
13223 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13224 fac 0 = 1
13225 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13226 #+END_SRC
13227 @end example
13228 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13229
13230 @example
13231 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13232 @end example
13233
13234 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13235 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13236 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13237 @cindex #+HEADER:
13238 @cindex #+HEADERS:
13239
13240 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13241
13242 @example
13243 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13244 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13245 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13246 #+END_SRC
13247
13248 #+RESULTS:
13249 : data1:1, data2:2
13250 @end example
13251
13252 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13253
13254 @example
13255 #+NAME: named-block
13256 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13257 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13258 (message "data:%S" data)
13259 #+END_SRC
13260
13261 #+RESULTS: named-block
13262 : data:2
13263 @end example
13264
13265 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13266 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13267 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13268
13269 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13270 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13271 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13272 blocks}.
13273
13274 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13275 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13276
13277 @example
13278 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13279 @end example
13280
13281 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13282 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13283
13284 @example
13285 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13286 @end example
13287
13288 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13289 @subsection Specific header arguments
13290 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13291 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13292
13293 @menu
13294 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13295 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13296 be collected and handled
13297 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13298 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13299 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13300 directory for code block execution
13301 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13302 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13303 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13304 files during tangling
13305 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13306 code files
13307 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13308 code files
13309 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13310 expansion during tangling
13311 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13312 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13313 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13314 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13315 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13316 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13317 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13318 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13319 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13320 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13321 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13322 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13323 @end menu
13324
13325 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13326 @ref{Languages}.
13327
13328 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13329 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13330 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13331 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13332 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13333 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13334 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13335
13336 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13337 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13338 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13339 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13340 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13341 code blocks.
13342
13343 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13344 Indexable variable values}).
13345
13346 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13347 @code{:var} header argument.
13348
13349 @example
13350 :var name=assign
13351 @end example
13352
13353 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13354 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13355 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13356 results of evaluating another code block.
13357
13358 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13359
13360 @table @dfn
13361
13362 @item table
13363 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13364
13365 @example
13366 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13367 | 1 |
13368 | 2 |
13369 | 3 |
13370 | 4 |
13371
13372 #+NAME: table-length
13373 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13374 (length table)
13375 #+END_SRC
13376
13377 #+RESULTS: table-length
13378 : 4
13379 @end example
13380
13381 @item list
13382 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13383 carried through to the source code block)
13384
13385 @example
13386 #+NAME: example-list
13387 - simple
13388 - not
13389 - nested
13390 - list
13391
13392 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13393 (print x)
13394 #+END_SRC
13395
13396 #+RESULTS:
13397 | simple | list |
13398 @end example
13399
13400 @item code block without arguments
13401 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13402 optionally followed by parentheses
13403
13404 @example
13405 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13406 (* 2 length)
13407 #+END_SRC
13408
13409 #+RESULTS:
13410 : 8
13411 @end example
13412
13413 @item code block with arguments
13414 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13415 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13416 code block name using standard function call syntax
13417
13418 @example
13419 #+NAME: double
13420 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13421 (* 2 input)
13422 #+END_SRC
13423
13424 #+RESULTS: double
13425 : 16
13426
13427 #+NAME: squared
13428 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13429 (* input input)
13430 #+END_SRC
13431
13432 #+RESULTS: squared
13433 : 4
13434 @end example
13435
13436 @item literal example
13437 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13438
13439 @example
13440 #+NAME: literal-example
13441 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
13442 A literal example
13443 on two lines
13444 #+END_EXAMPLE
13445
13446 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13447 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13448 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13449 #+END_SRC
13450
13451 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13452 : A literal example
13453 : on two lines for you.
13454
13455 @end example
13456
13457 @end table
13458
13459 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13460 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13461 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13462 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13463 following the source name.
13464
13465 @example
13466 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13467 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13468 (* 2 (+ input x))
13469 #+END_SRC
13470 @end example
13471
13472 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13473 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13474 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13475 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13476 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13477 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13478 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13479 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13480 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13481
13482 @example
13483 #+NAME: example-table
13484 | 1 | a |
13485 | 2 | b |
13486 | 3 | c |
13487 | 4 | d |
13488
13489 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13490 data
13491 #+END_SRC
13492
13493 #+RESULTS:
13494 : a
13495 @end example
13496
13497 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13498 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13499 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13500 to @code{data}.
13501
13502 @example
13503 #+NAME: example-table
13504 | 1 | a |
13505 | 2 | b |
13506 | 3 | c |
13507 | 4 | d |
13508 | 5 | 3 |
13509
13510 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13511 data
13512 #+END_SRC
13513
13514 #+RESULTS:
13515 | 2 | b |
13516 | 3 | c |
13517 | 4 | d |
13518 @end example
13519
13520 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13521 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13522 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13523 column is referenced.
13524
13525 @example
13526 #+NAME: example-table
13527 | 1 | a |
13528 | 2 | b |
13529 | 3 | c |
13530 | 4 | d |
13531
13532 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13533 data
13534 #+END_SRC
13535
13536 #+RESULTS:
13537 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
13538 @end example
13539
13540 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13541 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13542 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13543
13544 @example
13545 #+NAME: 3D
13546 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13547 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13548 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13549 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13550 #+END_SRC
13551
13552 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13553 data
13554 #+END_SRC
13555
13556 #+RESULTS:
13557 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
13558 @end example
13559
13560 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13561
13562 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13563 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13564 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13565 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13566 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13567 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13568 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13569 evaluation of the code block body.
13570
13571 @example
13572 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13573 wc -w $filename
13574 #+END_SRC
13575 @end example
13576
13577 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13578 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13579
13580 @example
13581 #+NAME: table
13582 | (a b c) |
13583
13584 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13585 #+BEGIN_SRC perl
13586 $data
13587 #+END_SRC
13588
13589 #+RESULTS:
13590 : (a b c)
13591 @end example
13592
13593 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13594 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13595
13596 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13597 per class may be supplied per code block.
13598
13599 @itemize @bullet
13600 @item
13601 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13602 from the code block
13603 @item
13604 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13605 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13606 Org mode buffer
13607 @item
13608 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13609 block should be handled.
13610 @end itemize
13611
13612 @subsubheading Collection
13613 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13614 should be collected from the code block.
13615
13616 @itemize @bullet
13617 @item @code{value}
13618 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13619 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13620 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13621 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13622 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13623 @item @code{output}
13624 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13625 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13626 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13627 @end itemize
13628
13629 @subsubheading Type
13630
13631 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13632 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13633 table or scalar depending on their value.
13634
13635 @itemize @bullet
13636 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13637 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13638 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13639 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13640 @item @code{list}
13641 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13642 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13643 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13644 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13645 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13646 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13647 @item @code{file}
13648 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13649 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13650 @item @code{raw}
13651 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13652 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13653 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13654 @item @code{org}
13655 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13656 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13657 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13658 @item @code{html}
13659 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13660 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13661 @item @code{latex}
13662 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13663 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13664 @item @code{code}
13665 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13666 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13667 @item @code{pp}
13668 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13669 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13670 @code{:results value pp}.
13671 @item @code{drawer}
13672 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13673 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13674 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13675 @end itemize
13676
13677 @subsubheading Handling
13678 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13679 results once they are collected.
13680
13681 @itemize @bullet
13682 @item @code{silent}
13683 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13684 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13685 @item @code{replace}
13686 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13687 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13688 @code{:results output replace}.
13689 @item @code{append}
13690 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13691 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13692 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13693 @item @code{prepend}
13694 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13695 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13696 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13697 @end itemize
13698
13699 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13700 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13701
13702 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13703 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13704 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13705 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13706 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13707 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13708 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13709 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13710
13711 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13712 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13713 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13714
13715 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13716 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13717
13718 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13719 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13720 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13721 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13722 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13723
13724 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13725 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13726
13727 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13728 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13729 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13730 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13731 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13732 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13733 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13734
13735 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13736 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13737 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13738
13739 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13740 in your home directory, you could use
13741
13742 @example
13743 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13744 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13745 #+END_SRC
13746 @end example
13747
13748 @subsubheading Remote execution
13749 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13750 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13751
13752 @example
13753 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13754 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13755 #+END_SRC
13756 @end example
13757
13758 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13759 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13760 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13761 created.
13762
13763 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13764 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13765
13766 @example
13767 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13768 @end example
13769
13770 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13771 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13772 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13773 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13774
13775 @subsubheading Further points
13776
13777 @itemize @bullet
13778 @item
13779 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13780 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13781 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13782 @item
13783 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13784 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13785 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13786 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13787 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13788 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13789 which the link does not point.
13790 @end itemize
13791
13792 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13793 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13794
13795 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13796 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13797
13798 @itemize @bullet
13799 @item @code{code}
13800 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13801 @code{:exports code}.
13802 @item @code{results}
13803 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13804 @code{:exports results}.
13805 @item @code{both}
13806 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13807 @code{:exports both}.
13808 @item @code{none}
13809 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13810 @end itemize
13811
13812 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13813 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13814
13815 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13816 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13817
13818 @itemize @bullet
13819 @item @code{tangle}
13820 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13821 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13822 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13823 @item @code{no}
13824 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13825 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13826 @item other
13827 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13828 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13829 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13830 @end itemize
13831
13832 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13833 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13834
13835 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13836 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13837 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13838
13839 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13840 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13841 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13842 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13843 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13844 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13845
13846 @itemize @bullet
13847 @item @code{no}
13848 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13849 @item @code{link}
13850 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13851 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13852 @item @code{yes}
13853 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13854 @item @code{org}
13855 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13856
13857 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13858 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13859 @item @code{both}
13860 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13861 @item @code{noweb}
13862 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13863 references in the code block body in link comments.
13864 @end itemize
13865
13866 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13867 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13868 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13869 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13870 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13871 are accepted.
13872
13873 @itemize @bullet
13874 @item @code{yes}
13875 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13876 @item @code{no}
13877 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13878 @end itemize
13879
13880 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13881 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13882
13883 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13884 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13885 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13886 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13887 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13888
13889 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13890 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13891
13892 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13893 language where state is preserved.
13894
13895 By default, a session is not started.
13896
13897 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13898 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13899 interpreted language.
13900
13901 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13902 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13903
13904 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13905 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13906 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13907 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13908 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13909
13910 @itemize @bullet
13911 @item @code{no}
13912 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13913 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13914 @item @code{yes}
13915 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13916 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13917 @item @code{tangle}
13918 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13919 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13920 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13921 @item @code{no-export}
13922 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13923 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13924 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13925 @item @code{strip-export}
13926 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13927 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13928 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13929 @item @code{eval}
13930 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13931 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13932 @end itemize
13933
13934 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13935 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13936 @code{<<reference>>}.
13937 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13938 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13939 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13940
13941 This code block:
13942
13943 @example
13944 -- <<example>>
13945 @end example
13946
13947 expands to:
13948
13949 @example
13950 -- this is the
13951 -- multi-line body of example
13952 @end example
13953
13954 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13955 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13956 references.
13957
13958 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13959 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13960 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13961 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13962 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13963 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13964
13965 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13966 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13967 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13968 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13969 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13970 inheritance}).}.
13971
13972 @example
13973 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13974 <<fullest-disk>>
13975 #+END_SRC
13976 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13977 :PROPERTIES:
13978 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13979 :END:
13980
13981 ** query all mounted disks
13982 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13983 df \
13984 #+END_SRC
13985
13986 ** strip the header row
13987 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13988 |sed '1d' \
13989 #+END_SRC
13990
13991 ** sort by the percent full
13992 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13993 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
13994 #+END_SRC
13995
13996 ** extract the mount point
13997 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13998 |awk '@{print $2@}'
13999 #+END_SRC
14000 @end example
14001
14002 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14003 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14004 newline is used.
14005
14006 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14007 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14008
14009 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14010 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14011 used.
14012
14013 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14014 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14015
14016 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14017 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14018 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14019 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14020 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14021 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14022 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14023
14024 @itemize @bullet
14025 @item @code{no}
14026 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14027 every time it is called.
14028 @item @code{yes}
14029 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14030 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14031 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14032 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14033 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14034 @end itemize
14035
14036 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14037 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14038 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14039 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14040 changed since it was last run.
14041
14042 @example
14043 #+NAME: random
14044 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14045 runif(1)
14046 #+END_SRC
14047
14048 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14049 0.4659510825295
14050
14051 #+NAME: caller
14052 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14053 x
14054 #+END_SRC
14055
14056 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14057 0.254227238707244
14058 @end example
14059
14060 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14061 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14062
14063 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14064 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14065 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14066 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14067 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14068 header argument.
14069
14070 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14071 delimited.
14072
14073 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14074 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14075
14076 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14077 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14078 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14079
14080 @itemize @bullet
14081 @item @code{no}
14082 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14083 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14084 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14085 default value yields the following results.
14086
14087 @example
14088 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14089 | a | b | c |
14090 |---+---+---|
14091 | d | e | f |
14092 |---+---+---|
14093 | g | h | i |
14094
14095 #+NAME: echo-table
14096 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14097 return tab
14098 #+END_SRC
14099
14100 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14101 | a | b | c |
14102 | d | e | f |
14103 | g | h | i |
14104 @end example
14105
14106 @item @code{yes}
14107 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14108
14109 @example
14110 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14111 | a | b | c |
14112 |---+---+---|
14113 | d | e | f |
14114 |---+---+---|
14115 | g | h | i |
14116
14117 #+NAME: echo-table
14118 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14119 return tab
14120 #+END_SRC
14121
14122 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14123 | a | b | c |
14124 |---+---+---|
14125 | d | e | f |
14126 |---+---+---|
14127 | g | h | i |
14128 @end example
14129 @end itemize
14130
14131 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14132 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14133
14134 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14135 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14136 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14137 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14138 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14139 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14140
14141 @itemize @bullet
14142 @item @code{nil}
14143 If an input table looks like it has column names
14144 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14145 names will be removed from the table before
14146 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14147
14148 @example
14149 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14150 | a |
14151 |---|
14152 | b |
14153 | c |
14154
14155 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14156 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14157 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14158 #+END_SRC
14159
14160 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14161 | a |
14162 |----|
14163 | b* |
14164 | c* |
14165 @end example
14166
14167 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14168 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14169
14170 @item @code{no}
14171 No column name pre-processing takes place
14172
14173 @item @code{yes}
14174 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14175 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14176 hline)
14177 @end itemize
14178
14179 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14180 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14181
14182 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14183 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14184
14185 @itemize @bullet
14186 @item @code{no}
14187 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14188
14189 @item @code{yes}
14190 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14191 and is then reapplied to the results.
14192
14193 @example
14194 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14195 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14196 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14197
14198 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14199 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14200 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14201 #+END_SRC
14202
14203 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14204 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14205 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14206 @end example
14207
14208 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14209 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14210
14211 @end itemize
14212
14213 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14214 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14215
14216 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14217 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14218 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14219 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14220
14221 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14222 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14223 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14224 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14225 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14226 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14227 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14228 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14229
14230 @table @code
14231 @item never or no
14232 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14233 @item query
14234 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14235 @item never-export or no-export
14236 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14237 interactively.
14238 @item query-export
14239 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14240 @end table
14241
14242 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14243 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14244 security}.
14245
14246 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14247 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14248 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14249 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14250 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14251 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14252 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14253
14254 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14255 @section Results of evaluation
14256 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14257 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14258
14259 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14260 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14261 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14262 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14263
14264 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14265 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14266 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14267 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14268 @end multitable
14269
14270 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14271 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14272 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14273
14274 @subsection Non-session
14275 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14276 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14277 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14278 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14279 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14280 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14281 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14282
14283 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14284 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14285
14286 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14287 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14288 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14289 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14290 future work.)
14291
14292 @subsection Session
14293 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14294 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14295 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14296 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14297 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14298 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14299 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14300 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14301
14302 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14303 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14304 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14305 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14306 in R).
14307
14308 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14309 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14310 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14311 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14312 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14313 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14314 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14315
14316 @example
14317 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14318 print "hello"
14319 2
14320 print "bye"
14321 #+END_SRC
14322
14323 #+RESULTS:
14324 : hello
14325 : bye
14326 @end example
14327
14328 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14329
14330 @example
14331 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14332 print "hello"
14333 2
14334 print "bye"
14335 #+END_SRC
14336
14337 #+RESULTS:
14338 : hello
14339 : 2
14340 : bye
14341 @end example
14342
14343 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14344 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14345 unnecessary here).
14346
14347 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14348 @section Noweb reference syntax
14349 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14350 @cindex syntax, noweb
14351 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14352
14353 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14354 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14355 familiar Noweb syntax:
14356
14357 @example
14358 <<code-block-name>>
14359 @end example
14360
14361 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14362 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14363 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14364 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14365 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14366 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14367
14368 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14369 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14370 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14371
14372 @example
14373 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14374 @end example
14375
14376 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14377 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14378 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14379 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14380 the default value.
14381
14382 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14383 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14384 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14385 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14386 argument.
14387
14388 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14389 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14390 @cindex code block, key bindings
14391
14392 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14393 the context.
14394
14395 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14396 are active:
14397
14398 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14399 @kindex C-c C-c
14400 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14401 @kindex C-c C-o
14402 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14403 @kindex C-up
14404 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14405 @kindex M-down
14406 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14407 @end multitable
14408
14409 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14410
14411 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14412 @kindex C-c C-v p
14413 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14414 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14415 @kindex C-c C-v n
14416 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14417 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14418 @kindex C-c C-v e
14419 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14420 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14421 @kindex C-c C-v o
14422 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14423 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14424 @kindex C-c C-v v
14425 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14426 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14427 @kindex C-c C-v u
14428 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14429 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14430 @kindex C-c C-v g
14431 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14432 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14433 @kindex C-c C-v r
14434 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14435 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14436 @kindex C-c C-v b
14437 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14438 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14439 @kindex C-c C-v s
14440 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14441 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14442 @kindex C-c C-v d
14443 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14444 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14445 @kindex C-c C-v t
14446 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14447 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14448 @kindex C-c C-v f
14449 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14450 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14451 @kindex C-c C-v c
14452 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14453 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14454 @kindex C-c C-v j
14455 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14456 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14457 @kindex C-c C-v l
14458 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14459 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14460 @kindex C-c C-v i
14461 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14462 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14463 @kindex C-c C-v I
14464 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14465 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14466 @kindex C-c C-v z
14467 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14468 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14469 @kindex C-c C-v a
14470 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14471 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14472 @kindex C-c C-v h
14473 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14474 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14475 @kindex C-c C-v x
14476 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14477 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14478 @end multitable
14479
14480 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14481 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14482
14483 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14484 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14485 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14486 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14487 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14488 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14489 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14490 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14491 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14492 @c @end multitable
14493
14494 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14495 @section Batch execution
14496 @cindex code block, batch execution
14497 @cindex source code, batch execution
14498
14499 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14500 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14501
14502 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14503
14504 @example
14505 #!/bin/sh
14506 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14507 #
14508 # tangle files with org-mode
14509 #
14510 DIR=`pwd`
14511 FILES=""
14512
14513 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14514 for i in $@@; do
14515 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14516 done
14517
14518 emacs -Q --batch \
14519 --eval "(progn
14520 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14521 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14522 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14523 (mapc (lambda (file)
14524 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14525 (org-babel-tangle)
14526 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14527 @end example
14528
14529 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14530 @chapter Miscellaneous
14531
14532 @menu
14533 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14534 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14535 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14536 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14537 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14538 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14539 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14540 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14541 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14542 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14543 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14544 @end menu
14545
14546
14547 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14548 @section Completion
14549 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14550 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14551 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14552 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14553 @cindex completion, of tags
14554 @cindex completion, of property keys
14555 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14556 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14557 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14558 @cindex dictionary word completion
14559 @cindex option keyword completion
14560 @cindex tag completion
14561 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14562
14563 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14564 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14565 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14566 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14567 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14568
14569 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14570 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14571 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14572
14573 @table @kbd
14574 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14575 @item M-@key{TAB}
14576 Complete word at point
14577 @itemize @bullet
14578 @item
14579 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14580 @item
14581 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14582 @item
14583 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14584 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14585 @item
14586 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14587 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14588 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14589 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14590 @item
14591 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14592 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14593 buffer.
14594 @item
14595 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14596 @item
14597 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14598 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14599 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14600 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14601 @item
14602 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14603 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14604 @item
14605 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14606 @end itemize
14607 @end table
14608
14609 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14610 @section Easy Templates
14611 @cindex template insertion
14612 @cindex insertion, of templates
14613
14614 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14615 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14616 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14617 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14618 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14619
14620 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14621 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14622 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14623
14624 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14625
14626 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14627 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14628 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14629 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14630 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14631 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14632 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14633 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14634 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14635 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14636 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14637 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14638 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14639 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14640 @end multitable
14641
14642 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14643 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14644
14645 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14646 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14647 additional details.
14648
14649 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14650 @section Speed keys
14651 @cindex speed keys
14652 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14653 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14654
14655 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14656 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14657 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14658 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14659 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14660 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14661 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14662 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14663
14664 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14665 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14666
14667 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14668 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14669
14670 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14671
14672 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14673 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14674 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14675 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14676 these precautions intact.
14677
14678 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14679 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14680 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14681
14682 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14683
14684 @table @i
14685 @item Source code blocks
14686 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14687 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14688 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14689 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14690 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14691
14692 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14693 which take off the default security brakes.
14694
14695 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14696 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14697 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14698 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14699 ask and nil not to ask.
14700 @end defopt
14701
14702 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14703 without asking:
14704
14705 @example
14706 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14707 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14708 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14709 @end example
14710
14711 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14712 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14713 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14714 not visible.
14715
14716 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14717 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14718 @end defopt
14719 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14720 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14721 @end defopt
14722
14723 @item Formulas in tables
14724 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14725 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14726 @end table
14727
14728 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14729 @section Customization
14730 @cindex customization
14731 @cindex options, for customization
14732 @cindex variables, for customization
14733
14734 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14735 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14736 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14737 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14738 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14739 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14740 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14741
14742 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14743 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14744 @cindex in-buffer settings
14745 @cindex special keywords
14746
14747 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14748 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14749 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14750 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14751 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14752 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14753 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14754 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14755 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14756
14757 @vindex org-archive-location
14758 @table @kbd
14759 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14760 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14761 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14762 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14763 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14764 @item #+CATEGORY:
14765 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14766 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14767 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14768 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14769 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14770 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14771 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14772 applies.
14773 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14774 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14775 @vindex org-table-formula
14776 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14777 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14778 The global version of this variable is
14779 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14780 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14781 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14782 top-level entries.
14783 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14784 @vindex org-drawers
14785 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14786 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14787 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14788 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14789 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14790 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14791 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14792 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14793 @vindex org-highest-priority
14794 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14795 @vindex org-default-priority
14796 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14797 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
14798 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14799 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14800 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14801 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14802 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14803 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14804 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14805 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14806 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14807 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14808 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14809 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14810 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14811 @item #+STARTUP:
14812 @cindex #+STARTUP:
14813 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14814 Org file is being visited.
14815
14816 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14817 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14818 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14819 @code{overview}.
14820 @vindex org-startup-folded
14821 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14822 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14823 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14824 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14825 @example
14826 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14827 content @r{all headlines}
14828 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14829 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14830 @end example
14831
14832 @vindex org-startup-indented
14833 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14834 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14835 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14836 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14837 @example
14838 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14839 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14840 @end example
14841
14842 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14843 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14844 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14845 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14846 @code{nil}.
14847 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14848 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14849 @example
14850 align @r{align all tables}
14851 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14852 @end example
14853
14854 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14855 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14856 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14857 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14858 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14859 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14860 @example
14861 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14862 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14863 @end example
14864
14865 @vindex org-log-done
14866 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14867 @vindex org-log-repeat
14868 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14869 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14870 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14871 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14872 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14873 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14874 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14875 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14876 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14877 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14878 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14879 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14880 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14881 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14883 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14884 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14885 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14888 @example
14889 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14890 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14891 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14892 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14893 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14894 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14895 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14896 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14897 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14898 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14899 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14900 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14901 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14902 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14903 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14904 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14905 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14906 @end example
14907 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14908 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14909 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14910 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14911 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14912 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14913 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14914 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14915 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14916 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14917 @example
14918 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14919 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14920 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14921 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14922 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14923 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14924 @end example
14925 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14926 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14927 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14928 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14929 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14930 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14931 @example
14932 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14933 @end example
14934 @vindex constants-unit-system
14935 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14936 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14937 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14938 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14939 @example
14940 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14941 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14942 @end example
14943 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14944 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14945 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14946 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14947 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14948 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14949 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14950 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14951 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14952 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14953 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14954 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14955 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14956 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14957 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14958 @example
14959 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14960 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14961 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14962 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14963 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14964 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14965 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14966 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14967 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14968 @end example
14969 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14970 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14971 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14972 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14973 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14974 @example
14975 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14976 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14977 @end example
14978 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14979 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14980 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14981 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14982 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14983 @example
14984 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14985 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14986 @end example
14987 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14988 @vindex org-tag-alist
14989 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14990 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14991 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14992 @item #+TBLFM:
14993 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
14994 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
14995 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
14996 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
14997 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
14998 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
14999 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15000 @ref{Export options}.
15001 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15002 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15003 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15004 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15005 @end table
15006
15007 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15008 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15009 @kindex C-c C-c
15010 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15011
15012 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15013 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15014 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15015 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15016 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15017 what this means in different contexts.
15018
15019 @itemize @minus
15020 @item
15021 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15022 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15023 @item
15024 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15025 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15026 information.
15027 @item
15028 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15029 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15030 @item
15031 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15032 the entire table.
15033 @item
15034 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15035 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15036 default location.
15037 @item
15038 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15039 corresponding links in this buffer.
15040 @item
15041 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15042 drawer, offer property commands.
15043 @item
15044 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15045 definition, and vice versa.
15046 @item
15047 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15048 @item
15049 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15050 of the checkbox.
15051 @item
15052 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15053 ordered list.
15054 @item
15055 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15056 block is updated.
15057 @item
15058 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15059 @end itemize
15060
15061 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15062 @section A cleaner outline view
15063 @cindex hiding leading stars
15064 @cindex dynamic indentation
15065 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15066 @cindex clean outline view
15067
15068 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15069 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15070 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15071 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15072 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15073
15074 @example
15075 @group
15076 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15077 ** Second level | * Second level
15078 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15079 some text | some text
15080 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15081 more text | more text
15082 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15083 @end group
15084 @end example
15085
15086 @noindent
15087
15088 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15089 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15090 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15091 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15092 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15093 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15094 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15095 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15096 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15097 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15098 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15099 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15100 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15101 @code{nil}.}; see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15102 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15103 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15104 individual files using
15105
15106 @example
15107 #+STARTUP: indent
15108 @end example
15109
15110 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15111 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15112 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15113 the following way:
15114
15115 @enumerate
15116 @item
15117 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15118 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15119 with the headline, like
15120
15121 @example
15122 *** 3rd level
15123 more text, now indented
15124 @end example
15125
15126 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15127 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15128 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15129 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15130
15131 @item
15132 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15133 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15134 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15135 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15136 with
15137
15138 @example
15139 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15140 #+STARTUP: showstars
15141 @end example
15142
15143 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15144
15145 @example
15146 @group
15147 * Top level headline
15148 * Second level
15149 * 3rd level
15150 ...
15151 @end group
15152 @end example
15153
15154 @noindent
15155 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15156 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15157 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15158 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15159 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15160 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15161 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15162
15163 @item
15164 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15165 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15166 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15167 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15168 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15169 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15170 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15171 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15172 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15173
15174 @example
15175 #+STARTUP: odd
15176 #+STARTUP: oddeven
15177 @end example
15178
15179 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15180 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15181 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15182 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15183 @end enumerate
15184
15185 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15186 @section Using Org on a tty
15187 @cindex tty key bindings
15188
15189 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15190 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15191 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15192 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15193 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15194 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15195 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15196 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15197 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15198 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15199 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15200
15201 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15202 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15203 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15204 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15205 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15206 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15207 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15208 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15209 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15210 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15211 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15212 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15213 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15214 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15215 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15216 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15217 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15218 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15219 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15220 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15221 @end multitable
15222
15223
15224 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15225 @section Interaction with other packages
15226 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15227 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15228 with other code out there.
15229
15230 @menu
15231 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15232 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15233 @end menu
15234
15235 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15236 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15237
15238 @table @asis
15239 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15240 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15241 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15242 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15243 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15244 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15245 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15246 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15247 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15248 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15249 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15250 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15251 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15252 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15253 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15254 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15255 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15256 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15257 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15258 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15259 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15260 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15261 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15262 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15263 @file{constants.el}.
15264 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15265 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15266 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15267 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15268 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15269 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15270 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15271 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15272 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15273 @lisp
15274 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15275 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15276 @end lisp
15277 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15278 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15279 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15280 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15281 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15282 @cindex Wiegley, John
15283 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15284 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15285 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15286 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15287 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15288 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15289 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15290 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15291 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15292 @cindex @file{table.el}
15293 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15294 @kindex C-c C-c
15295 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15296 @cindex @file{table.el}
15297 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15298
15299 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15300 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15301 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15302 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15303 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15304 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15305 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15306
15307 @table @kbd
15308 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15309 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15310 @c
15311 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15312 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15313 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15314 format. See the documentation string of the command
15315 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15316 possible.
15317 @end table
15318 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15319 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15320 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15321 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15322 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15323 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15324 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15325 @end table
15326
15327 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15328 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15329
15330 @table @asis
15331
15332 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15333 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15334 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15335 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15336 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15337 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15338 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15339 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15340 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15341 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15342 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15343 cursor moves across a special context.
15344
15345 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15346 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15347 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15348 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15349 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15350 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15351 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15352 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15353 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15354 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15355 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15356 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15357 buffer (but not during date selection).
15358
15359 @example
15360 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15361 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15362 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15363 @end example
15364
15365 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15366 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15367 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15368 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15369
15370 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15371 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15372
15373 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15374 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15375 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15376 this:
15377
15378 @lisp
15379 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15380 @end lisp
15381
15382 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15383 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15384 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15385 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15386 fixed this problem:
15387
15388 @lisp
15389 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15390 (lambda ()
15391 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15392 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15393 @end lisp
15394
15395 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15396 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15397 function:
15398
15399 @lisp
15400 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15401 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15402 @end lisp
15403
15404 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15405
15406 @lisp
15407 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15408 (lambda ()
15409 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15410 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15411 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15412 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15413 @end lisp
15414
15415 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15416 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15417 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15418 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15419 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15420 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15421 configuration:
15422
15423 @lisp
15424 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15425 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15426 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15427 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15428 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15429 @end lisp
15430
15431 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15432 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15433 @kindex C-c /
15434 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15435 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15436 another key for this command, or override the key in
15437 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15438
15439 @lisp
15440 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15441 @end lisp
15442
15443 @end table
15444
15445 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15446 @section org-crypt.el
15447 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15448 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15449
15450 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15451 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15452 files.
15453
15454 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15455 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15456 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15457
15458 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15459 @file{.emacs}:
15460
15461 @example
15462 (require 'org-crypt)
15463 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15464 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15465
15466 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15467 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15468 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15469
15470 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15471 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15472 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15473 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15474 ;; start Org.
15475
15476 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15477 ;;
15478 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15479 @end example
15480
15481 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15482 being encrypted again.
15483
15484 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15485 @appendix Hacking
15486 @cindex hacking
15487
15488 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15489 Org.
15490
15491 @menu
15492 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15493 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15494 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15495 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15496 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15497 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15498 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15499 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15500 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15501 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15502 @end menu
15503
15504 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15505 @section Hooks
15506 @cindex hooks
15507
15508 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15509 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15510 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15511 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15512 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15513
15514 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15515 @section Add-on packages
15516 @cindex add-on packages
15517
15518 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15519 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15520 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15521 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15522 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15523 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15524
15525
15526
15527 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15528 @section Adding hyperlink types
15529 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15530
15531 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15532 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15533 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15534 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15535 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15536 Emacs:
15537
15538 @lisp
15539 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15540
15541 (require 'org)
15542
15543 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15544 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15545
15546 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15547 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15548 :group 'org-link
15549 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15550
15551 (defun org-man-open (path)
15552 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15553 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15554 (funcall org-man-command path))
15555
15556 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15557 "Store a link to a manpage."
15558 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15559 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15560 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15561 (link (concat "man:" page))
15562 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15563 (org-store-link-props
15564 :type "man"
15565 :link link
15566 :description description))))
15567
15568 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15569 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15570 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15571 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15572 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15573 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15574
15575 (provide 'org-man)
15576
15577 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15578 @end lisp
15579
15580 @noindent
15581 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15582
15583 @lisp
15584 (require 'org-man)
15585 @end lisp
15586
15587 @noindent
15588 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15589 @enumerate
15590 @item
15591 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15592 loaded.
15593 @item
15594 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15595 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15596 that will be called to follow such a link.
15597 @item
15598 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15599 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15600 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15601 buffer displaying a man page.
15602 @end enumerate
15603
15604 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15605 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15606 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15607 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15608 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15609 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15610 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15611
15612 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15613 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15614 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15615 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15616 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15617 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15618 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15619 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15620 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15621 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15622 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15623 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15624
15625 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15626 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15627 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15628 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15629
15630 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15631 @section Context-sensitive commands
15632 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15633 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15634 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15635
15636 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15637 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15638 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15639
15640 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15641 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15642 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15643 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15644 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15645 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15646 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15647 @code{#+RR:}.
15648
15649 @lisp
15650 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15651 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15652 (if (save-excursion
15653 (beginning-of-line 1)
15654 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15655 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15656 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15657 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15658
15659 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15660 @end lisp
15661
15662 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15663 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15664 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15665 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15666 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15667
15668
15669 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15670 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15671 @cindex tables, in other modes
15672 @cindex lists, in other modes
15673 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15674
15675 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15676 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15677 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15678 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15679 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15680 editor.
15681
15682 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15683 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15684 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15685 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15686 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15687 for a very flexible system.
15688
15689 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15690 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15691 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15692 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15693
15694
15695 @menu
15696 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15697 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15698 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15699 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15700 @end menu
15701
15702 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15703 @subsection Radio tables
15704 @cindex radio tables
15705
15706 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15707 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15708 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15709 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15710
15711 @example
15712 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15713 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15714 @end example
15715
15716 @noindent
15717 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15718 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15719 example:
15720 @cindex #+ORGTBL
15721 @example
15722 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15723 @end example
15724
15725 @noindent
15726 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15727 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15728 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15729 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15730 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15731 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15732 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15733
15734 @table @code
15735 @item :skip N
15736 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15737 this parameter!
15738
15739 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15740 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15741 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15742 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15743 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15744 additional columns.
15745
15746 @item :no-escape t
15747 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15748 the table. The default value is nil.
15749 @end table
15750
15751 @noindent
15752 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15753 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15754 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15755 number of different solutions:
15756
15757 @itemize @bullet
15758 @item
15759 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15760 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15761 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15762 @item
15763 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15764 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15765 in @LaTeX{}.
15766 @item
15767 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15768 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15769 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15770 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15771 key.
15772 @end itemize
15773
15774 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15775 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15776 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15777
15778 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15779 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15780 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15781 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15782 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15783 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15784 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15785 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15786 will then get the following template:
15787
15788 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15789 @example
15790 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15791 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15792 \begin@{comment@}
15793 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15794 | | |
15795 \end@{comment@}
15796 @end example
15797
15798 @noindent
15799 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15800 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15801 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15802 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15803 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15804 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15805 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15806 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15807 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15808 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15809 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15810 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15811
15812 @example
15813 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15814 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15815 \begin@{comment@}
15816 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15817 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15818 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15819 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15820 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15821 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15822 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15823 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15824 \end@{comment@}
15825 @end example
15826
15827 @noindent
15828 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15829 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15830
15831 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15832 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15833 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15834 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15835 header and footer commands of the target table:
15836
15837 @example
15838 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15839 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15840 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15841 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15842 \end@{tabular@}
15843 %
15844 \begin@{comment@}
15845 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15846 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15847 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15848 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15849 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15850 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15851 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15852 \end@{comment@}
15853 @end example
15854
15855 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15856 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15857 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15858 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15859
15860 @table @code
15861 @item :splice nil/t
15862 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15863 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15864
15865 @item :fmt fmt
15866 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15867 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15868 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15869 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15870 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15871 function must return a formatted string.
15872
15873 @item :efmt efmt
15874 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15875 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15876 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15877 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15878 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15879 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15880 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15881 supplied instead of strings.
15882 @end table
15883
15884 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15885 @subsection Translator functions
15886 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15887 @cindex translator function
15888
15889 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15890 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15891 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15892 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15893 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15894 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15895 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15896 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15897 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15898
15899 @lisp
15900 @group
15901 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15902 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15903 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15904 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15905 (params2
15906 (list
15907 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15908 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15909 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15910 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15911 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15912 @end group
15913 @end lisp
15914
15915 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15916 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15917 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
15918 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15919 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15920 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15921 overrule the default with
15922
15923 @example
15924 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15925 @end example
15926
15927 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15928 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15929 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15930 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15931 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15932 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15933 a single line!):
15934
15935 @example
15936 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15937 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15938 @end example
15939
15940 @noindent
15941 Please check the documentation string of the function
15942 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15943 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15944 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15945 using the generic function.
15946
15947 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15948 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15949 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15950 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15951 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15952 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15953 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15954 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15955 others can benefit from your work.
15956
15957 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15958 @subsection Radio lists
15959 @cindex radio lists
15960 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15961
15962 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15963 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15964 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15965 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15966
15967 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15968
15969 @itemize @minus
15970 @item
15971 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15972 @item
15973 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15974 @item
15975 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15976 parameters.
15977 @item
15978 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15979 @end itemize
15980
15981 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15982 @LaTeX{} file:
15983
15984 @cindex #+ORGLST
15985 @example
15986 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15987 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15988 \begin@{comment@}
15989 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15990 - a new house
15991 - a new computer
15992 + a new keyboard
15993 + a new mouse
15994 - a new life
15995 \end@{comment@}
15996 @end example
15997
15998 Pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
15999 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16000
16001 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16002 @section Dynamic blocks
16003 @cindex dynamic blocks
16004
16005 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16006 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16007 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16008 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16009
16010 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16011 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16012 the content of the block.
16013
16014 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16015 @example
16016 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16017
16018 #+END:
16019 @end example
16020
16021 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16022
16023 @table @kbd
16024 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16025 Update dynamic block at point.
16026 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16027 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16028 @end table
16029
16030 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16031 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16032 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16033 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16034 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16035
16036 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16037 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16038 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16039 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16040 run:
16041
16042 @example
16043 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16044
16045 #+END:
16046 @end example
16047
16048 @noindent
16049 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16050
16051 @lisp
16052 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16053 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16054 (insert "Last block update at: "
16055 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16056 @end lisp
16057
16058 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16059 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16060 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16061 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16062 @code{org-mode}.
16063
16064 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16065 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16066
16067 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16068 @section Special agenda views
16069 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16070
16071 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16072 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16073 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16074 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16075 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16076 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16077 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16078 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16079 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16080 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16081 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16082
16083 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16084 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16085 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16086 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16087 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16088 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16089
16090 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16091 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16092 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16093 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16094 search should continue from there.
16095
16096 @lisp
16097 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16098 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16099 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16100 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16101 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16102 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16103 @end lisp
16104
16105 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16106 like this:
16107
16108 @lisp
16109 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16110 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16111 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16112 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16113 @end lisp
16114
16115 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16116 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16117 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16118
16119 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16120 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16121 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16122 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16123 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16124 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16125 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16126 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16127 you really want to have.
16128
16129 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16130 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16131 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16132
16133 @table @code
16134 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16135 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16136 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16137 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16138 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16139 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16140 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16141 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16142 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16143 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16144 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16145 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16146 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16147 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16148 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16149 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16150 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16151 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16152 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16153 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16154 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16155 @end table
16156
16157 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16158 like this, even without defining a special function:
16159
16160 @lisp
16161 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16162 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16163 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16164 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16165 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16166 @end lisp
16167
16168 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16169 @section Extracting agenda information
16170 @cindex agenda, pipe
16171 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16172
16173 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16174 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16175 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16176 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16177 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16178 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16179 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16180 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16181 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16182 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16183 current TODO list, you could use
16184
16185 @example
16186 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16187 @end example
16188
16189 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16190 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16191 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16192 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16193
16194 @example
16195 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16196 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16197 @end example
16198
16199 @noindent
16200 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16201
16202 @example
16203 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16204 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16205 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16206 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16207 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16208 | lpr
16209 @end example
16210
16211 @noindent
16212 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16213 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16214
16215 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16216 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16217 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16218 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16219 are:
16220
16221 @example
16222 category @r{The category of the item}
16223 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16224 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16225 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16226 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16227 diary @r{imported from diary}
16228 deadline @r{a deadline}
16229 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16230 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16231 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16232 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16233 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16234 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16235 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16236 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16237 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16238 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16239 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16240 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16241 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16242 @end example
16243
16244 @noindent
16245 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16246 led to the selection of the item.
16247
16248 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16249 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16250 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16251
16252 @example
16253 #!/usr/bin/perl
16254
16255 # define the Emacs command to run
16256 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16257
16258 # run it and capture the output
16259 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16260
16261 # loop over all lines
16262 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16263 # get the individual values
16264 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16265 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16266 # process and print
16267 print "[ ] $head\n";
16268 @}
16269 @end example
16270
16271 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16272 @section Using the property API
16273 @cindex API, for properties
16274 @cindex properties, API
16275
16276 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16277 properties.
16278
16279 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16280 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16281 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16282 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16283 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16284 if the property key was used several times.@*
16285 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16286 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16287 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16288 @end defun
16289 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16290 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16291 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16292 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16293 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16294 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16295 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16296 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16297 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16298 @end defun
16299
16300 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16301 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16302 @end defun
16303
16304 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16305 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16306 @end defun
16307
16308 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16309 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16310 @end defun
16311
16312 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16313 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16314 @end defun
16315
16316 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16317 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16318 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16319 @end defun
16320
16321 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16322 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16323 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16324 @end defun
16325
16326 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16327 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16328 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16329 @end defun
16330
16331 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16332 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16333 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16334 @end defun
16335
16336 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16337 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16338 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16339 @end defun
16340
16341 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16342 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16343 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16344 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16345 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16346 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16347 responsible for this property.
16348 @end defopt
16349
16350 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16351 @section Using the mapping API
16352 @cindex API, for mapping
16353 @cindex mapping entries, API
16354
16355 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16356 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16357 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16358 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16359 is:
16360
16361 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16362 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16363
16364 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16365 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16366 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16367 returned as a list.
16368
16369 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16370 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16371 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16372 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16373 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16374 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16375 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16376 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16377 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16378 position.
16379
16380 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16381 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16382 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16383 visited by the iteration.
16384
16385 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16386
16387 @example
16388 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16389 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16390 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16391 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16392 file-with-archives
16393 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16394 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16395 agenda-with-archives
16396 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16397 (file1 file2 ...)
16398 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16399 @end example
16400 @noindent
16401 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16402 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16403
16404 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16405 @example
16406 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16407 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16408 function or Lisp form
16409 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16410 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16411 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16412 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16413 @end example
16414 @end defun
16415
16416 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16417 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16418 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16419 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16420
16421 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16422 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16423 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16424 @end defun
16425
16426 @defun org-priority &optional action
16427 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16428 possible values for ACTION.
16429 @end defun
16430
16431 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16432 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16433 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16434 @end defun
16435
16436 @defun org-promote
16437 Promote the current entry.
16438 @end defun
16439
16440 @defun org-demote
16441 Demote the current entry.
16442 @end defun
16443
16444 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16445 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16446 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16447
16448 @lisp
16449 (org-map-entries
16450 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16451 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16452 @end lisp
16453
16454 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16455 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16456
16457 @lisp
16458 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16459 @end lisp
16460
16461 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16462 @appendix MobileOrg
16463 @cindex iPhone
16464 @cindex MobileOrg
16465
16466 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16467 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16468 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16469 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16470 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16471 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16472 Moreland. Android users should check out
16473 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16474 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16475 features.
16476
16477 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16478 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16479 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16480
16481 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16482 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16483 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16484 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16485 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16486 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16487 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16488
16489 @menu
16490 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16491 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16492 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16493 @end menu
16494
16495 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16496 @section Setting up the staging area
16497
16498 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16499 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16500 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16501 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16502 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16503 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16504 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16505 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16506 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16507 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16508 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16509
16510 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16511 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16512 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16513 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16514 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16515 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16516 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16517 Emacs about it:
16518
16519 @lisp
16520 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16521 @end lisp
16522
16523 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16524 and to read captured notes from there.
16525
16526 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16527 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16528
16529 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16530 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16531 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16532 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16533 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16534 inside this directory@footnote{Symbolic links in @code{org-directory} need to
16535 have the same name than their targets.}.
16536
16537 The push operation also creates a special Org file @file{agendas.org} with
16538 all custom agenda view defined by the user@footnote{While creating the
16539 agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on all referenced entries, so that
16540 these entries can be uniquely identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for
16541 further action. If you do not want to get these properties in so many
16542 entries, you can set the variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}
16543 to @code{nil}. Org mode will then rely on outline paths, in the hope that
16544 these will be unique enough.}.
16545
16546 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16547 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16548 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16549 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16550 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16551
16552 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16553 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16554
16555 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16556 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16557 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16558 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16559 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16560
16561 @enumerate
16562 @item
16563 Org moves all entries found in
16564 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16565 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16566 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16567 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16568 @item
16569 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16570 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16571 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16572 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16573 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16574 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16575 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16576 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16577 @item
16578 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16579 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16580 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16581 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16582 agenda line.
16583 @table @kbd
16584 @kindex ?
16585 @item ?
16586 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16587 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16588 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16589 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16590 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16591 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16592 this flagged entry is finished.
16593 @end table
16594 @end enumerate
16595
16596 @kindex C-c a ?
16597 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16598 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16599 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16600 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16601 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16602 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16603 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16604
16605 @node History and Acknowledgments, GNU Free Documentation License, MobileOrg, Top
16606 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16607 @cindex acknowledgments
16608 @cindex history
16609 @cindex thanks
16610
16611 @section From Carsten
16612
16613 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16614 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16615 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16616 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16617 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16618 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16619 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16620 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16621 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16622 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16623 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16624 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16625 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16626 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16627 functionality directly into a notes file.
16628
16629 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16630 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16631 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16632 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16633 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16634 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16635 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16636 let me know.
16637
16638 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16639
16640 @table @i
16641 @item Bastien Guerry
16642 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16643 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16644 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16645 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16646 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16647 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16648 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16649 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16650 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16651 programming and reproducible research.
16652 @item John Wiegley
16653 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16654 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16655 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16656 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16657 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16658 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16659 @item Sebastian Rose
16660 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16661 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16662 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16663 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16664 single-key navigation.
16665 @end table
16666
16667 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16668 let me know what I am missing here!
16669
16670 @section From Bastien
16671
16672 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16673 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16674 to Carsten's ones above.
16675
16676 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16677 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16678 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16679
16680 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16681 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16682 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16683 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16684 either of the code or the community:
16685
16686 @table @i
16687 @item Eric Schulte
16688 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16689 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16690
16691 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16692 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16693 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16694 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16695
16696 @item Jambunathan K
16697 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16698 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16699 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16700 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16701
16702 @item Achim Gratz
16703 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16704 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16705 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16706
16707 @item Nick Dokos
16708 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16709 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16710 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16711 @end table
16712
16713 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16714 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
16715 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16716
16717 @section List of contributions
16718
16719 @itemize @bullet
16720
16721 @item
16722 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16723 @item
16724 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16725 @item
16726 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16727 Org mode website.
16728 @item
16729 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16730 @item
16731 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16732 @item
16733 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16734 @item
16735 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16736 @item
16737 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16738 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16739 @item
16740 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16741 specified time.
16742 @item
16743 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16744 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16745 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16746 @item
16747 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16748 @item
16749 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16750 @item
16751 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16752 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16753 them.
16754 @item
16755 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16756 @item
16757 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16758 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16759 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16760 @item
16761 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16762 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16763 @item
16764 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16765 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16766 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16767 @item
16768 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16769 HTML agendas.
16770 @item
16771 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16772 @item
16773 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16774 @item
16775 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16776 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16777 @item
16778 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16779 @item
16780 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16781 @item
16782 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16783 @item
16784 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16785 testing.
16786 @item
16787 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16788 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16789 @item
16790 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16791 @item
16792 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16793 @item
16794 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16795 @item
16796 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16797 book.
16798 @item
16799 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16800 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16801 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16802 @item
16803 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16804 patches.
16805 @item
16806 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16807 @item
16808 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16809 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16810 @item
16811 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16812 @item
16813 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16814 @item
16815 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16816 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16817 @item
16818 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16819 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16820 @item
16821 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16822 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16823 small fixes and patches.
16824 @item
16825 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16826 @item
16827 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16828 @item
16829 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16830 basis.
16831 @item
16832 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16833 happy.
16834 @item
16835 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16836 @item
16837 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16838 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16839 @item
16840 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16841 @item
16842 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16843 @item
16844 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16845 file links, and TAGS.
16846 @item
16847 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16848 version of the reference card.
16849 @item
16850 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16851 into Japanese.
16852 @item
16853 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16854 @item
16855 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16856 links, among other things.
16857 @item
16858 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16859 provided frequent feedback.
16860 @item
16861 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16862 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16863 @item
16864 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16865 @item
16866 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16867 control.
16868 @item
16869 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16870 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16871 @item
16872 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16873 @item
16874 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16875 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16876 @item
16877 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16878 extensive patches.
16879 @item
16880 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16881 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16882 @item
16883 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16884 other things.
16885 @item
16886 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16887 @item
16888 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16889 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16890 @item
16891 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16892 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16893 @item
16894 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16895 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16896 @item
16897 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16898 subtrees.
16899 @item
16900 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16901 @item
16902 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16903 tweaks and features.
16904 @item
16905 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16906 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16907 @item
16908 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16909 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16910 @item
16911 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16912 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16913 @item
16914 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16915 chapter about publishing.
16916 @item
16917 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16918 @item
16919 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16920 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16921 @item
16922 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16923 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16924 concept index for HTML export.
16925 @item
16926 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16927 in HTML output.
16928 @item
16929 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16930 @item
16931 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16932 keyword.
16933 @item
16934 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16935 system.
16936 @item
16937 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16938 linking to Gnus.
16939 @item
16940 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16941 work on a tty.
16942 @item
16943 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16944 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16945 @end itemize
16946
16947
16948 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Main Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16949 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
16950 @include doclicense.texi
16951
16952
16953 @node Main Index, Key Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
16954 @unnumbered Concept index
16955
16956 @printindex cp
16957
16958 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16959 @unnumbered Key index
16960
16961 @printindex ky
16962
16963 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16964 @unnumbered Command and function index
16965
16966 @printindex fn
16967
16968 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16969 @unnumbered Variable index
16970
16971 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16972 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16973 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16974
16975 @printindex vr
16976
16977 @bye
16978
16979 @c Local variables:
16980 @c fill-column: 77
16981 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16982 @c paragraph-start: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16983 @c paragraph-separate: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16984 @c End:
16985
16986
16987 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre